blob: a2133cdc9ae5e2506c0fa30f3312fd775b36dcec [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau15480d72014-06-19 21:10:58 +02005 version 1.6
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau8747b6d2015-03-11 23:57:23 +01007 2015/03/11
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020053
544. Proxies
554.1. Proxy keywords matrix
564.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
57
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200585. Bind and Server options
595.1. Bind options
605.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200615.3. Server DNS resolution
625.3.1. Global overview
635.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020064
656. HTTP header manipulation
66
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200677. Using ACLs and fetching samples
687.1. ACL basics
697.1.1. Matching booleans
707.1.2. Matching integers
717.1.3. Matching strings
727.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
737.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
747.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
757.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
767.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200777.3.1. Converters
787.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
797.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
807.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
817.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
827.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200837.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020084
858. Logging
868.1. Log levels
878.2. Log formats
888.2.1. Default log format
898.2.2. TCP log format
908.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100918.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100928.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200938.3. Advanced logging options
948.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
958.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
968.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
978.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
988.4. Timing events
998.5. Session state at disconnection
1008.6. Non-printable characters
1018.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1028.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1038.9. Examples of logs
104
1059. Statistics and monitoring
1069.1. CSV format
1079.2. Unix Socket commands
108
109
1101. Quick reminder about HTTP
111----------------------------
112
113When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
114fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
115on almost anything found in the contents.
116
117However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
118formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
119correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
120
121
1221.1. The HTTP transaction model
123-------------------------------
124
125The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100126to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200127from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
128connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
129will involve a new connection :
130
131 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
132
133In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
134establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
135by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
136length.
137
138Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
139to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
140however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
141response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
142header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
143
144 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
145
146Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
147power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
148but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200149a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200150
151A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
152keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
153second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
154page :
155
156 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
157
158This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
159latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
160correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
161the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100162server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200163
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100164By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
165connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
166leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
167start of a new request.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200168
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100169HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
170 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
171 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
172 everything else is forwarded with no analysis.
173 - passive close : tunnel with "Connection: close" added in both directions.
174 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
175 - forced close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
176
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177
1781.2. HTTP request
179-----------------
180
181First, let's consider this HTTP request :
182
183 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100184 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200185 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
186 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
187 3 User-agent: my small browser
188 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
189 5 Accept: image/png
190
191
1921.2.1. The Request line
193-----------------------
194
195Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
196
197 - a METHOD : GET
198 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
199 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
200
201All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
202which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
203followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
204is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
205desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
206the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
207
208The URI itself can have several forms :
209
210 - A "relative URI" :
211
212 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
213
214 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
215 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
216
217 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
218
219 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
220
221 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
222 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
223 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
224 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
225 must accept this form too.
226
227 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
228 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
229 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100230
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200231 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
232 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
233 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
234 other protocols too.
235
236In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
237mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
238on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
239It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
240specific to the language, framework or application in use.
241
242
2431.2.2. The request headers
244--------------------------
245
246The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
247beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
248an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
249Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
250values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
251encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
252the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
253define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
254
255Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
256their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
257"Connection:" header).
258
259The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
260that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
261is one valid form of empty line.
262
263Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
264headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
265about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
266application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
267
268Important note:
269 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
270 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
271 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
272 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
273
274
2751.3. HTTP response
276------------------
277
278An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
279messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
280
281 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100282 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200283 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
284 2 Content-length: 350
285 3 Content-Type: text/html
286
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200287As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
288codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
289response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100290continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
291the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
292following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
293sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
294(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
295correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
296such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
297state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
298over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
299if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
300information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200301
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200302
3031.3.1. The Response line
304------------------------
305
306Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
307
308 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
309 - a status code : 200
310 - a reason : OK
311
312The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200313 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200314 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
315 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
316 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
317 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
318
319Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100320"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200321found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
322messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
323or "Authentication Required".
324
325Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
326
327 Code When / reason
328 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
329 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
330 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
331 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100332 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
333 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200334 400 for an invalid or too large request
335 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
336 accessing the stats page)
337 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
338 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
339 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
340 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
341 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
342 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
343 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
344 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
345 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
346
347The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3484.2).
349
350
3511.3.2. The response headers
352---------------------------
353
354Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
355the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
356details.
357
358
3592. Configuring HAProxy
360----------------------
361
3622.1. Configuration file format
363------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200364
365HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
366
367 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
368 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
369 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
370 "frontend" and "backend".
371
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100372The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
373referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200374delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100375
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200376
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02003772.2. Quoting and escaping
378-------------------------
379
380HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
381many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
382with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
383single quotes.
384
385If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
386them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
387escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
388
389Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
390
391 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
392 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
393 \\ to use a backslash
394 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
395 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
396
397Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
398the interpretation of:
399
400 space as a parameter separator
401 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
402 # hash as a comment start
403
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200404Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
405-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
406backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
407
408Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200409quoting.
410
411Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
412nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
413
414Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
415equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
416
417 Example:
418 # those are equivalents:
419 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
420 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
421 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
422 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
423 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
424
425 # those are equivalents:
426 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
427 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
428 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
429 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
430
431
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004322.3. Environment variables
433--------------------------
434
435HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
436interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
437configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
438optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
439shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
440underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
441
442 Example:
443
444 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
445
446 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
447
448 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
449
450
4512.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200452----------------
453
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100454Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100455values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
456otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
457numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
458for every keyword. Supported units are :
459
460 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
461 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
462 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
463 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
464 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
465 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
466
467
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02004682.4. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200469-------------
470
471 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
472 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
473 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
474 global
475 daemon
476 maxconn 256
477
478 defaults
479 mode http
480 timeout connect 5000ms
481 timeout client 50000ms
482 timeout server 50000ms
483
484 frontend http-in
485 bind *:80
486 default_backend servers
487
488 backend servers
489 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
490
491
492 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
493 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
494 global
495 daemon
496 maxconn 256
497
498 defaults
499 mode http
500 timeout connect 5000ms
501 timeout client 50000ms
502 timeout server 50000ms
503
504 listen http-in
505 bind *:80
506 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
507
508
509Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
510
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100511 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200512
513
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005143. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200515--------------------
516
517Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
518are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
519of them have command-line equivalents.
520
521The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
522
523 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200524 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200525 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200526 - crt-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200527 - daemon
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900528 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200529 - gid
530 - group
531 - log
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100532 - log-send-hostname
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200533 - nbproc
534 - pidfile
535 - uid
536 - ulimit-n
537 - user
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200538 - stats
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100539 - ssl-server-verify
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200540 - node
541 - description
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100542 - unix-bind
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100543 - 51degrees-data-file
544 - 51degrees-property-name-list
545 - 51degrees-property-seperator
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100546
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200547 * Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200548 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200549 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200550 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100551 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100552 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100553 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200554 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200555 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200556 - maxsslrate
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200557 - noepoll
558 - nokqueue
559 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100560 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300561 - nogetaddrinfo
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200562 - spread-checks
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200563 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200564 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100565 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100566 - tune.http.cookielen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200567 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100568 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100569 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100570 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100571 - tune.lua.session-timeout
572 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100573 - tune.maxaccept
574 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200575 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200576 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200577 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100578 - tune.rcvbuf.client
579 - tune.rcvbuf.server
580 - tune.sndbuf.client
581 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100582 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100583 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200584 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100585 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200586 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200587 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200588 - tune.vars.global-max-size
589 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
590 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
591 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100592 - tune.zlib.memlevel
593 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100594
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200595 * Debugging
596 - debug
597 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200598
599
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006003.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200601------------------------------------
602
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200603ca-base <dir>
604 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200605 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
606 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200607
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200608chroot <jail dir>
609 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
610 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
611 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
612 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
613 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
614 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100615
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100616cpu-map <"all"|"odd"|"even"|process_num> <cpu-set>...
617 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process to a specific CPU
618 set. This means that the process will never run on other CPUs. The "cpu-map"
619 directive specifies CPU sets for process sets. The first argument is the
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100620 process number to bind. This process must have a number between 1 and 32 or
621 64, depending on the machine's word size, and any process IDs above nbproc
622 are ignored. It is possible to specify all processes at once using "all",
623 only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like with the
624 "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are CPU sets.
625 Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a range with
626 two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers or ranges
627 may be specified, and the processes will be allowed to bind to all of them.
628 Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be specified. Each "cpu-map"
629 directive will replace the previous ones when they overlap.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100630
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200631crt-base <dir>
632 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
633 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
634 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
635
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200636daemon
637 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
638 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
639 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
640
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200641deviceatlas-json-file <path>
642 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
643 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by Haproxy process.
644
645deviceatlas-log-level <value>
646 Sets the level of informations returned by the API. This directive is
647 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
648
649deviceatlas-separator <char>
650 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
651 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
652
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900653external-check
654 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks.
655 This is disabled by default as a security precaution.
656 See "option external-check".
657
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200658gid <number>
659 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
660 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
661 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100662 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
663 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200664 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100665
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200666group <group name>
667 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
668 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100669
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200670log <address> [len <length>] <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200671 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
672 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100673 configured with "log global".
674
675 <address> can be one of:
676
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100677 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100678 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
679 port).
680
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100681 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
682 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
683 port).
684
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100685 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
686 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
687 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
688 writeable).
689
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200690 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
691 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100692
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200693 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
694 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
695 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
696 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
697 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
698 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
699 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
700 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
701 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
702 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
703 JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
704
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100705 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200706
707 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
708 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
709 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
710
711 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200712 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
713 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
714 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
715 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
716 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
717 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200718
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200719 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200720
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100721log-send-hostname [<string>]
722 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
723 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
724 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
725 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
726 the logs.
727
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000728log-tag <string>
729 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
730 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
731 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +0100732 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000733
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100734lua-load <file>
735 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
736 used multiple times.
737
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200738nbproc <number>
739 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
740 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
741 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
742 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
743 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
744
745pidfile <pidfile>
746 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
747 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
748 starting the process. See also "daemon".
749
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100750stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200751 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
752 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
753 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
754 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
755 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
756 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100757 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +0200758 word size (32 or 64). A better option consists in using the "process" setting
759 of the "stats socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200760
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100761ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
762 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
763 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300764 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake for all "bind" lines which
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100765 do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
766 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string such
767 as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes). Please check the
768 "bind" keyword for more information.
769
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100770ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
771 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
772 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
773 keyword to see available options.
774
775 Example:
776 global
777 ssl-default-bind-options no-sslv3 no-tls-tickets
778
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100779ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
780 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
781 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300782 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server, for all "server"
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100783 lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is
784 defined in "man 1 ciphers". Please check the "server" keyword for more
785 information.
786
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100787ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
788 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
789 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
790 keyword to see available options.
791
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +0200792ssl-dh-param-file <file>
793 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
794 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
795 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
796 which do not explicitely define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
797 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
798 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them directly
799 in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size specified
800 by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are known to be
801 more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
802 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
803 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
804 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
805
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100806ssl-server-verify [none|required]
807 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
808 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
809 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
810
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200811stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
812 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
813 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
814 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
815 consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" for more details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200816
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200817 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
818 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
819 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200820
821stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
822 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
823 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100824 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200825
826stats maxconn <connections>
827 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
828 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
829
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200830uid <number>
831 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
832 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
833 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
834 one. See also "gid" and "user".
835
836ulimit-n <number>
837 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
838 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
839 option.
840
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100841unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
842 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
843
844 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
845 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
846 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
847 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
848 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
849 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
850 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
851 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
852 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
853 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
854
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200855user <user name>
856 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
857 See also "uid" and "group".
858
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200859node <name>
860 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
861
862 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
863 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
864 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
865 traffic.
866
867description <text>
868 Add a text that describes the instance.
869
870 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
871 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
872 "<" and ">" characters.
873
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +010087451degrees-data-file <file path>
875 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
876 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevavnt permissions.
877
878 Please note that this options is only available when haproxy has been
879 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
880
88151degrees-property-name-list [<string>]
882 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
883 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
884 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
885
886 Please note that this options is only available when haproxy has been
887 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
888
88951degrees-property-seperator <char>
890 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
891 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
892
893 Please note that this options is only available when haproxy has been
894 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
895
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200896
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008973.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200898-----------------------
899
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200900max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
901 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
902 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
903 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
904 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
905 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
906 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
907 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
908 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
909
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200910maxconn <number>
911 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
912 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
913 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +0200914 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
915 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
916 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
917 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +0100918 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will default to the value
919 set in DEFAULT_MAXCONN at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) if no memory
920 limit is enforced, or will be computed based on the memory limit, the buffer
921 size, memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use or not of SSL
922 and the associated maxsslconn (which can also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200923
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200924maxconnrate <number>
925 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
926 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
927 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
928 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
929 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
930 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
931 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
932 fairness.
933
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100934maxcomprate <number>
935 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300936 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100937 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
938 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
939 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
940 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
941 default value.
942
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100943maxcompcpuusage <number>
944 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
945 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
946 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
947 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
948 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
949 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
950 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
951 process down and from introducing high latencies.
952
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100953maxpipes <number>
954 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
955 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
956 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
957 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
958 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
959 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
960
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200961maxsessrate <number>
962 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
963 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
964 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
965 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
966 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
967 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
968 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
969 fairness.
970
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200971maxsslconn <number>
972 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
973 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
974 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
975 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
976 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
977 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
978 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +0100979 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
980 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
981 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
982 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
983 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
984 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
985 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200986
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200987maxsslrate <number>
988 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
989 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
990 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
991 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
992 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
993 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
994 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
995 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
996 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
997 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
998
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +0100999maxzlibmem <number>
1000 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1001 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1002 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001003 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1004 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1005 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1006
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001007noepoll
1008 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1009 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001010 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001011
1012nokqueue
1013 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1014 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1015 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1016
1017nopoll
1018 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1019 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001020 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001021 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001022
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001023nosplice
1024 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
1025 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
1026 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001027 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001028 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1029 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1030 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1031 "option splice-response".
1032
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001033nogetaddrinfo
1034 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1035 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1036
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001037spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001038 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1039 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1040 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1041 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1042 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1043 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001044
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001045tune.buffers.limit <number>
1046 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1047 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1048 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1049 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1050 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
1051 behaviour. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
1052 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1053 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1054 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1055 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1056 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1057 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1058 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1059 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1060 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1061
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001062tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1063 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1064 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1065 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1066 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1067
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001068tune.bufsize <number>
1069 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1070 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1071 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1072 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1073 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1074 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1075 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
1076 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001077 If HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
1078 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
1079 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway).
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001080
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001081tune.chksize <number>
1082 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1083 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1084 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1085 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1086 checks whenever possible.
1087
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001088tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1089 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1090 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1091 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1092 this value. The default value is 1.
1093
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001094tune.http.cookielen <number>
1095 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1096 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1097 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1098 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1099 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1100 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1101 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1102 to change this value.
1103
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001104tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1105 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1106 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1107 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1108 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1109 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1110 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
1111 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. Keep in mind that each
1112 new header consumes 32bits of memory for each session, so don't push this
1113 limit too high.
1114
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001115tune.idletimer <timeout>
1116 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1117 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1118 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1119 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1120 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1121 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
1122 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (eg: read a page before
1123 clicking). There should be not reason for changing this value. Please check
1124 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1125
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001126tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1127 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
1128 instructions executed. This permits interruptng a long script and allows the
1129 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1130 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
1131 executes some Lua code but more reactivity is required, this value can be
1132 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1133 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1134
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001135tune.lua.maxmem
1136 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1137 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1138 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1139 memory.
1140
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001141tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1142 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
1143 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout has a
1144 priority over other timeouts. For example, if this timeout is set to 4s and
1145 you run a 5s sleep, the code will be interrupted with an error after waiting
1146 4s.
1147
1148tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1149 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1150 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1151 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1152 check servers.
1153
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001154tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01001155 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
1156 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
1157 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
1158 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
1159 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
1160 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
1161 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
1162 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
1163 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
1164 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001165
1166tune.maxpollevents <number>
1167 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1168 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1169 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1170 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1171 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1172
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001173tune.maxrewrite <number>
1174 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1175 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1176 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1177 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1178 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1179 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1180 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1181 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
1182 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
1183 bufsize.
1184
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001185tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
1186 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
1187 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
1188 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
1189 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
1190 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
1191 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
1192 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
1193 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
1194 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
1195 about 5 MB on 32-bit systems and 8 MB on 64-bit systems. There is a very low
1196 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
1197 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
1198 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
1199 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
1200 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
1201 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
1202 setting this parameter to 0.
1203
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001204tune.pipesize <number>
1205 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
1206 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
1207 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
1208 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
1209 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
1210 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
1211
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001212tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
1213tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
1214 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
1215 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1216 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1217 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
1218 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
1219 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1220 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1221
1222tune.sndbuf.client <number>
1223tune.sndbuf.server <number>
1224 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
1225 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1226 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1227 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
1228 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
1229 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1230 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1231 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
1232 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
1233 notifying haproxy again.
1234
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001235tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001236 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
1237 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
1238 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001239 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001240 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
1241 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
1242 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
1243 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
1244 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01001245 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
1246 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001247
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001248tune.ssl.force-private-cache
1249 This boolean disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
1250 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1251 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1252 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1253 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1254 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1255
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001256tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1257 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001258 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001259 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1260 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1261 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1262 being used for too long.
1263
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001264tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1265 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1266 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1267 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
1268 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1269 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1270 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1271 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1272 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1273 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1274 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001275 best value. Haproxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
1276 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001277
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001278tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
1279 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
1280 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
1281 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
1282 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
1283 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
1284 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
1285 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001286 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
1287 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001288
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001289tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
1290 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
1291 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
1292 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
1293 1000 entries.
1294
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001295tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
1296tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
1297tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
1298tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
1299 These four tunes helps to manage the allowed amount of memory used by the
1300 variables system. "global" limits the memory for all the systems. "sess" limit
1301 the memory by session, "txn" limits the memory by transaction and "reqres"
1302 limits the memory for each request or response processing. during the
1303 accounting, "sess" embbed "txn" and "txn" embed "reqres".
1304
1305 By example, we considers that "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is fixed to 100,
1306 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" is fixed to 100, "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" is
1307 also fixed to 100. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
1308 we cannot create any more variable in the other contexts.
1309
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001310tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
1311 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001312 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001313 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
1314 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
1315 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
1316
1317tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
1318 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
1319 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
1320 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
1321 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001322
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013233.3. Debugging
1324--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001325
1326debug
1327 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
1328 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
1329 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
1330 system startup.
1331
1332quiet
1333 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
1334 line argument "-q".
1335
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001336
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010013373.4. Userlists
1338--------------
1339It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
1340http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
1341it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
1342
1343userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001344 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001345 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
1346
1347group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001348 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001349 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
1350 proceeded by "users" keyword.
1351
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001352user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
1353 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001354 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
1355 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001356 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
1357 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001358 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001359 DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001360
1361
1362 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001363 userlist L1
1364 group G1 users tiger,scott
1365 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001366
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001367 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
1368 user scott insecure-password elgato
1369 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001370
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001371 userlist L2
1372 group G1
1373 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001374
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001375 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
1376 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
1377 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001378
1379 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001380
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001381
13823.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001383----------
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001384It is possible to synchronize server entries in stick tables between several
1385haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each instance
1386pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. Server IDs are used to
1387identify servers remotely, so it is important that configurations look similar
1388or at least that the same IDs are forced on each server on all participants.
1389Interrupted exchanges are automatically detected and recovered from the last
1390known point. In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to
1391the new one using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new
1392process tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication
1393during a reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large
1394tables.
1395
1396peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001397 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001398 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
1399
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02001400disabled
1401 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
1402 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
1403 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
1404
1405enable
1406 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
1407
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001408peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
1409 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
1410 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
1411 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
1412 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
1413 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
1414 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
1415
1416 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
1417 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
1418
1419 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
1420 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
1421 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
1422 across all peers.
1423
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001424 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1425 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001426
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001427 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001428 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001429 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
1430 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
1431 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001432
1433 backend mybackend
1434 mode tcp
1435 balance roundrobin
1436 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
1437 stick on src
1438
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001439 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1440 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001441
1442
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090014433.6. Mailers
1444------------
1445It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
1446If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
1447in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
1448
1449mailer <mailersect>
1450 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
1451 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
1452
1453mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
1454 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
1455
1456 Example:
1457 mailers mymailers
1458 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
1459 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
1460
1461 backend mybackend
1462 mode tcp
1463 balance roundrobin
1464
1465 email-alert mailers mymailers
1466 email-alert from test1@horms.org
1467 email-alert to test2@horms.org
1468
1469 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1470 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
1471
1472
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014734. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001474----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001475
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001476Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02001477 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001478 - frontend <name>
1479 - backend <name>
1480 - listen <name>
1481
1482A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
1483its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
1484section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001485section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001486
1487A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
1488connections.
1489
1490A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
1491to forward incoming connections.
1492
1493A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
1494parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
1495
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001496All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
1497'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
1498case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
1499
1500Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
1501logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
1502proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
1503However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
1504name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
1505
1506Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
1507and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001508bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001509protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
1510modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
1511arbitrary criteria.
1512
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001513In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
1514a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
1515the backend's. HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
1516
1517 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
1518 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
1519 between responses and new requests.
1520
1521 - TUN: tunnel ("option http-tunnel") : this was the default mode for versions
1522 1.0 to 1.5-dev21 : only the first request and response are processed, and
1523 everything else is forwarded with no analysis at all. This mode should not
1524 be used as it creates lots of trouble with logging and HTTP processing.
1525
1526 - PCL: passive close ("option httpclose") : exactly the same as tunnel mode,
1527 but with "Connection: close" appended in both directions to try to make
1528 both ends close after the first request/response exchange.
1529
1530 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
1531 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
1532 client-facing connection remains open.
1533
1534 - FCL: forced close ("option forceclose") : the connection is actively closed
1535 after the end of the response.
1536
1537The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
1538frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
1539following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
1540weakest option and force close is the strongest.
1541
1542 Backend mode
1543
1544 | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1545 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1546 KAL | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1547 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1548 TUN | TUN | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1549 Frontend ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1550 mode PCL | PCL | PCL | PCL | FCL | FCL
1551 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1552 SCL | SCL | SCL | FCL | SCL | FCL
1553 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1554 FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL
1555
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001556
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001557
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015584.1. Proxy keywords matrix
1559--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001560
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001561The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
1562limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
1563they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
1564limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001565marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001566option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02001567and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
1568with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
1569specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001570
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001571
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001572 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
1573------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1574acl - X X X
1575appsession - - X X
1576backlog X X X -
1577balance X - X X
1578bind - X X -
1579bind-process X X X X
1580block - X X X
1581capture cookie - X X -
1582capture request header - X X -
1583capture response header - X X -
1584clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001585compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001586contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1587cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02001588declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001589default-server X - X X
1590default_backend X X X -
1591description - X X X
1592disabled X X X X
1593dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001594email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09001595email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001596email-alert mailers X X X X
1597email-alert myhostname X X X X
1598email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001599enabled X X X X
1600errorfile X X X X
1601errorloc X X X X
1602errorloc302 X X X X
1603-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1604errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001605force-persist - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001606fullconn X - X X
1607grace X X X X
1608hash-type X - X X
1609http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01001610http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02001611http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001612http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02001613http-response - X X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02001614http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001615id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001616ignore-persist - X X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02001617log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01001618log-format X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001619log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02001620max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001621maxconn X X X -
1622mode X X X X
1623monitor fail - X X -
1624monitor-net X X X -
1625monitor-uri X X X -
1626option abortonclose (*) X - X X
1627option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
1628option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
1629option allbackups (*) X - X X
1630option checkcache (*) X - X X
1631option clitcpka (*) X X X -
1632option contstats (*) X X X -
1633option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
1634option dontlognull (*) X X X -
1635option forceclose (*) X X X X
1636-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1637option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02001638option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02001639option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01001640option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02001641option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02001642option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001643option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01001644option http-tunnel (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001645option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
1646option httpchk X - X X
1647option httpclose (*) X X X X
1648option httplog X X X X
1649option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001650option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02001651option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001652option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001653option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
1654option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
1655option logasap (*) X X X -
1656option mysql-check X - X X
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01001657option pgsql-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001658option nolinger (*) X X X X
1659option originalto X X X X
1660option persist (*) X - X X
1661option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02001662option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001663option smtpchk X - X X
1664option socket-stats (*) X X X -
1665option splice-auto (*) X X X X
1666option splice-request (*) X X X X
1667option splice-response (*) X X X X
1668option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1669option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1670-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01001671option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001672option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
1673option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
1674option tcpka X X X X
1675option tcplog X X X X
1676option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001677external-check command X - X X
1678external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001679persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1680rate-limit sessions X X X -
1681redirect - X X X
1682redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1683redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1684reqadd - X X X
1685reqallow - X X X
1686reqdel - X X X
1687reqdeny - X X X
1688reqiallow - X X X
1689reqidel - X X X
1690reqideny - X X X
1691reqipass - X X X
1692reqirep - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001693reqitarpit - X X X
1694reqpass - X X X
1695reqrep - X X X
1696-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001697reqtarpit - X X X
1698retries X - X X
1699rspadd - X X X
1700rspdel - X X X
1701rspdeny - X X X
1702rspidel - X X X
1703rspideny - X X X
1704rspirep - X X X
1705rsprep - X X X
1706server - - X X
1707source X - X X
1708srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02001709stats admin - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001710stats auth X - X X
1711stats enable X - X X
1712stats hide-version X - X X
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02001713stats http-request - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001714stats realm X - X X
1715stats refresh X - X X
1716stats scope X - X X
1717stats show-desc X - X X
1718stats show-legends X - X X
1719stats show-node X - X X
1720stats uri X - X X
1721-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1722stick match - - X X
1723stick on - - X X
1724stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02001725stick store-response - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001726stick-table - - X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02001727tcp-check connect - - X X
1728tcp-check expect - - X X
1729tcp-check send - - X X
1730tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02001731tcp-request connection - X X -
1732tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02001733tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02001734tcp-response content - - X X
1735tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001736timeout check X - X X
1737timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02001738timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001739timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
1740timeout connect X - X X
1741timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1742timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
1743timeout http-request X X X X
1744timeout queue X - X X
1745timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02001746timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001747timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1748timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02001749timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001750transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01001751unique-id-format X X X -
1752unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001753use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02001754use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001755------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1756 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001757
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001758
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017594.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
1760---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001761
1762This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
1763
1764
1765acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
1766 Declare or complete an access list.
1767 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1768 no | yes | yes | yes
1769 Example:
1770 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1771 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1772 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1773
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001774 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001775
1776
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001777appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
1778 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001779 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
1780 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1781 no | no | yes | yes
1782 Arguments :
1783 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
1784 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
1785
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001786 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001787 checked in each cookie value.
1788
1789 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
1790 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
1791 milliseconds.
1792
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02001793 request-learn
1794 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
1795 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
1796 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
1797 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
1798 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
1799 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
1800
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001801 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
1802 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
1803 data following this prefix.
1804
1805 Example :
1806 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
1807
1808 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
1809 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
1810
1811 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
1812 2 modes are currently supported :
1813 - path-parameters :
1814 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
1815 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
1816 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
1817 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
1818 - query-string :
1819 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
1820 query string.
1821
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001822 When an application cookie is defined in a backend, HAProxy will check when
1823 the server sets such a cookie, and will store its value in a table, and
1824 associate it with the server's identifier. Up to <length> characters from
1825 the value will be retained. On each connection, haproxy will look for this
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001826 cookie both in the "Cookie:" headers, and as a URL parameter (depending on
1827 the mode used). If a known value is found, the client will be directed to the
1828 server associated with this value. Otherwise, the load balancing algorithm is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001829 applied. Cookies are automatically removed from memory when they have been
1830 unused for a duration longer than <holdtime>.
1831
1832 The definition of an application cookie is limited to one per backend.
1833
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001834 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
1835 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
1836 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
1837
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001838 Example :
1839 appsession JSESSIONID len 52 timeout 3h
1840
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001841 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
1842 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001843
1844
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001845backlog <conns>
1846 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
1847 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1848 yes | yes | yes | no
1849 Arguments :
1850 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
1851 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001852 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001853
1854 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
1855 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
1856 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
1857 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
1858 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
1859 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
1860 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
1861 backlog parameter.
1862
1863 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
1864 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
1865 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
1866
1867 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
1868
1869
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001870balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001871balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001872 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
1873 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1874 yes | no | yes | yes
1875 Arguments :
1876 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
1877 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
1878 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
1879 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
1880
1881 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1882 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
1883 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
1884 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001885 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08001886 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001887 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
1888 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
1889 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
1890 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
1891 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
1892 it, so that you don't worry.
1893
1894 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1895 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
1896 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
1897 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
1898 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
1899 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
1900 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
1901 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001902
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01001903 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
1904 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
1905 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
1906 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
1907 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
1908 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
1909 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
1910 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
1911
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001912 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001913 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001914 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
1915 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001916 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001917 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
1918 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
1919 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
1920 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
1921 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001922 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
1923 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
1924 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
1925 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
1926 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
1927 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001928
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001929 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
1930 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
1931 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
1932 address will always reach the same server as long as no
1933 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
1934 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
1935 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
1936 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001937 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001938 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001939 static by default, which means that changing a server's
1940 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
1941 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001942
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001943 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
1944 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
1945 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
1946 the running servers. The result designates which server will
1947 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
1948 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
1949 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
1950 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
1951 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
1952 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1953 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1954 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001955
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001956 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001957 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
1958 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
1959 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
1960 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
1961 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
1962 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
1963 URIs start with a leading "/".
1964
1965 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
1966 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
1967 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
1968 evaluation stops when either is reached.
1969
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001970 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001971 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
1972
1973 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001974 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
1975 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001976 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
1977 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
1978 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
1979 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001980 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001981 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
1982 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001983
1984 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
1985 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
1986 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
1987 server will receive the request.
1988
1989 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
1990 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
1991 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
1992 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
1993 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001994 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
1995 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
1996 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001997
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001998 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
1999 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
2000 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
2001 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
2002 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002003
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002004 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002005 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
2006 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
2007 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
2008
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002009 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2010 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2011 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2012
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002013 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02002014 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002015 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
2016 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
2017 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
2018 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
2019 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
2020 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002021 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002022 used instead.
2023
2024 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
2025 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
2026 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
2027 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
2028
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002029 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2030 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2031 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2032
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002033 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09002034
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002035 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002036 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
2037 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002038
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01002039 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
2040 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
2041 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002042
2043 Examples :
2044 balance roundrobin
2045 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002046 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002047 balance hdr(User-Agent)
2048 balance hdr(host)
2049 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002050
2051 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
2052 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
2053
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002054 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002055 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
2056 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
2057 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
2058 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
2059
2060 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
2061 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
2062 defaults to 16 kB.
2063
2064 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
2065 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
2066
2067 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
2068 Round Robin.
2069
2070 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
2071 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
2072 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
2073 actually appeared in the first chunk).
2074
2075 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
2076
2077 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002078 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002079 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
2080 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
2081 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002082
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002083 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "appsession", "transparent", "hash-type" and
2084 "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002085
2086
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002087bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2088bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002089 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
2090 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2091 no | yes | yes | no
2092 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002093 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
2094 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
2095 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
2096 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01002097 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002098 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
2099 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
2100 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
2101 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
2102 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
2103 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
2104 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02002105 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
2106 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
2107 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
2108 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
2109 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
2110 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
2111 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01002112 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
2113 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
2114 be listening.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002115 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
2116 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
2117 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002118
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002119 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
2120 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002121 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
2122 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
2123 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002124 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
2125 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
2126 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
2127 the range.
2128
2129 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
2130 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
2131 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
2132 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
2133 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
2134 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
2135 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002136 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002137 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002138
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002139 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
2140 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
2141 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
2142 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
2143 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
2144 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
2145 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
2146 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
2147
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002148 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
2149 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
2150 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
2151 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002152
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002153 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
2154 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
2155 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
2156 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
2157 in a frontend.
2158
2159 Example :
2160 listen http_proxy
2161 bind :80,:443
2162 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002163 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002164
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002165 listen http_https_proxy
2166 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02002167 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002168
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002169 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
2170 bind ipv6@:80
2171 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
2172 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
2173
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002174 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002175 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002176
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002177 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002178 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002179
2180
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002181bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002182 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
2183 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2184 yes | yes | yes | yes
2185 Arguments :
2186 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
2187 may be used to override a default value.
2188
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002189 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002190 option may be combined with other numbers.
2191
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002192 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002193 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
2194 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
2195 missing from all processes.
2196
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002197 number The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002198 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02002199 the machine's word size. If a proxy is bound to process
2200 numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it will
2201 either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
2202 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002203
2204 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
2205 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
2206 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
2207 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
2208 and 'even' instances.
2209
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002210 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
2211 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
2212 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
2213 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002214
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002215 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
2216 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
2217
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02002218 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
2219 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
2220 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
2221
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002222 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
2223 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
2224
2225 Example :
2226 listen app_ip1
2227 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002228 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002229
2230 listen app_ip2
2231 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002232 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002233
2234 listen management
2235 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002236 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002237
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002238 listen management
2239 bind 10.0.0.4:80
2240 bind-process 1-4
2241
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002242 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002243
2244
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002245block { if | unless } <condition>
2246 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
2247 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2248 no | yes | yes | yes
2249
2250 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
2251 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002252 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02002253 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002254 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
2255 "block" statements per instance.
2256
2257 Example:
2258 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2259 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2260 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2261 block if invalid_src || local_dst
2262
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002263 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002264
2265
2266capture cookie <name> len <length>
2267 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
2268 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2269 no | yes | yes | no
2270 Arguments :
2271 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
2272 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
2273 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
2274 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
2275 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
2276
2277 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
2278 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
2279 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
2280 right if it exceeds <length>.
2281
2282 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
2283 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
2284 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
2285 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
2286
2287 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
2288 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
2289 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
2290
2291 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
2292 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
2293 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002294 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
2295 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
2296 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002297
2298 Example:
2299 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
2300
2301 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002302 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002303
2304
2305capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002306 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002307 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2308 no | yes | yes | no
2309 Arguments :
2310 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002311 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002312 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
2313 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2314 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2315
2316 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2317 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2318 it exceeds <length>.
2319
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002320 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002321 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
2322 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002323 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
2324 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
2325 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
2326 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002327 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002328 environments to find where the request came from.
2329
2330 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
2331 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
2332 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
2333 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002334
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002335 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
2336 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2337 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2338 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2339 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002340
2341 Example:
2342 capture request header Host len 15
2343 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
2344 capture request header Referrer len 15
2345
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002346 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002347 about logging.
2348
2349
2350capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002351 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002352 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2353 no | yes | yes | no
2354 Arguments :
2355 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002356 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002357 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
2358 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2359 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2360
2361 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2362 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2363 it exceeds <length>.
2364
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002365 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002366 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
2367 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
2368 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002369 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
2370 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
2371 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
2372 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002373
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002374 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
2375 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2376 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2377 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2378 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002379
2380 Example:
2381 capture response header Content-length len 9
2382 capture response header Location len 15
2383
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002384 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002385 about logging.
2386
2387
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002388clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002389 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
2390 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2391 yes | yes | yes | no
2392 Arguments :
2393 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2394 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2395 as explained at the top of this document.
2396
2397 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
2398 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
2399 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
2400 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
2401 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
2402 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
2403 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
2404 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002405 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002406 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
2407 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
2408
2409 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
2410 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2411 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2412 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2413 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
2414 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2415
2416 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
2417 Please use "timeout client" instead.
2418
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01002419 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
2420 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002421
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002422compression algo <algorithm> ...
2423compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002424compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002425 Enable HTTP compression.
2426 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2427 yes | yes | yes | yes
2428 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002429 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
2430 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
2431 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
2432
2433 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002434 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
2435 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
2436 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002437
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002438 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
2439 support for zlib was built in.
2440
2441 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
2442 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
2443 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
2444 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
2445 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
2446 for zlib was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002447
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002448 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
2449 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
2450 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
2451 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
2452 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
2453 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
2454 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
2455 available when support for zlib was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002456
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002457 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002458 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002459 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
2460 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
2461 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
2462 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
2463 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002464
2465 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
2466 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
2467 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
2468 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
2469 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002470 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
2471 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
2472 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
2473 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
2474 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02002475 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
2476 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002477
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002478 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002479 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
2480 "Accept-Encoding" header
2481 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
William Lallemandd3002612012-11-26 14:34:47 +01002482 * HTTP status code is not 200
William Lallemand8bb4e342013-12-10 17:28:48 +01002483 * response header "Transfer-Encoding" contains "chunked" (Temporary
2484 Workaround)
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002485 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
2486 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
2487 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
2488 "multipart"
2489 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
2490 header
2491 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
2492 and later
2493 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
2494 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002495
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002496 Note: The compression does not rewrite Etag headers, and does not emit the
2497 Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002498
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002499 Examples :
2500 compression algo gzip
2501 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002502
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002503contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002504 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
2505 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2506 yes | no | yes | yes
2507 Arguments :
2508 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2509 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2510 as explained at the top of this document.
2511
2512 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002513 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002514 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002515 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
2516 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
2517 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
2518 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
2519
2520 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
2521 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2522 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2523 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2524 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
2525 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2526
2527 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
2528 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
2529 instead.
2530
2531 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
2532 "timeout server", "contimeout".
2533
2534
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02002535cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002536 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
2537 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002538 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
2539 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2540 yes | no | yes | yes
2541 Arguments :
2542 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
2543 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
2544 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
2545 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
2546 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
2547 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
2548 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
2549 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
2550 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
2551
2552 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
2553 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
2554 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
2555 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
2556 headers is left to the application. The application can then
2557 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
2558 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode only
2559 works in HTTP close mode. Unless the application behaviour is
2560 very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to start with this
2561 mode for new deployments. This keyword is incompatible with
2562 "insert" and "prefix".
2563
2564 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002565 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002566
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002567 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002568 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
2569 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
2570 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
2571 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
2572 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
2573 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
2574 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
2575 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
2576 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
2577 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002578
2579 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
2580 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
2581 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
2582 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
2583 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
2584 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
2585 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
2586 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
2587 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
2588 this mode requires the HTTP close mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002589 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
2590 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
2591 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002592
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002593 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
2594 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
2595 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002596 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
2597 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
2598 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
2599 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002600 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
2601 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
2602 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002603
2604 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
2605 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
2606 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
2607 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
2608 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
2609 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
2610 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
2611 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
2612 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
2613
2614 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
2615 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
2616 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
2617 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
2618 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
2619 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
2620 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
2621 persistence cookie in the cache.
2622 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
2623
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002624 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
2625 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
2626 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
2627 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
2628 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
2629 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
2630 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
2631 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
2632 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
2633 they logout.
2634
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002635 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
2636 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
2637 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
2638 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
2639
2640 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
2641 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
2642 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
2643 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
2644 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
2645 this attribute.
2646
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002647 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002648 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01002649 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
2650 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
2651 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
2652 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
2653 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
2654 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002655
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002656 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
2657 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
2658 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
2659 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
2660 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
2661 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
2662 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
2663 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2664 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
2665 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
2666 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
2667 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
2668 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
2669 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
2670 the site.
2671
2672 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
2673 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
2674 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
2675 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
2676 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
2677 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
2678 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
2679 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
2680 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
2681 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
2682 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
2683 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
2684 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2685 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
2686 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
2687 redispatch after some absolute delay.
2688
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002689 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
2690 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
2691 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
2692 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002693
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002694 Examples :
2695 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
2696 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
2697 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002698 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002699
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002700 See also : "appsession", "balance source", "capture cookie", "server"
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002701 and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002702
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002703
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002704declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
2705 Declares a capture slot.
2706 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2707 no | yes | yes | no
2708 Arguments:
2709 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
2710
2711 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
2712 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
2713 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
2714 for use in the response.
2715
2716 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
2717 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
2718
2719
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002720default-server [param*]
2721 Change default options for a server in a backend
2722 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2723 yes | no | yes | yes
2724 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002725 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2726 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2727 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2728 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002729
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002730 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002731 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
2732
2733 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002734
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002735
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002736default_backend <backend>
2737 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
2738 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2739 yes | yes | yes | no
2740 Arguments :
2741 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
2742
2743 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
2744 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
2745 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
2746 will catch all undetermined requests.
2747
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002748 Example :
2749
2750 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
2751 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
2752 default_backend dynamic
2753
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02002754 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002755
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002756
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02002757description <string>
2758 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
2759 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2760 no | yes | yes | yes
2761 Arguments : string
2762
2763 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
2764 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
2765 it describes.
2766 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
2767
2768
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002769disabled
2770 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2771 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2772 yes | yes | yes | yes
2773 Arguments : none
2774
2775 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
2776 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
2777 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
2778 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
2779 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
2780 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
2781 keyword in a "defaults" section.
2782
2783 See also : "enabled"
2784
2785
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002786dispatch <address>:<port>
2787 Set a default server address
2788 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2789 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002790 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002791
2792 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
2793 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
2794 during start-up.
2795
2796 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
2797 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
2798 possible with normal servers.
2799
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02002800 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002801 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
2802 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
2803 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
2804 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
2805
2806 See also : "server"
2807
2808
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002809enabled
2810 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2811 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2812 yes | yes | yes | yes
2813 Arguments : none
2814
2815 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
2816 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
2817
2818 See also : "disabled"
2819
2820
2821errorfile <code> <file>
2822 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2823 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2824 yes | yes | yes | yes
2825 Arguments :
2826 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
CJ Ess108b1dd2015-04-07 12:03:37 -04002827 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 429, 500, 502, 503, and
2828 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002829
2830 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002831 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002832 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002833 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2834 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002835
2836 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2837 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2838 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2839
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002840 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2841
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002842 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
2843 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
2844 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
2845 files returning the same contents as default errors.
2846
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002847 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
2848 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
2849 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
2850 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
2851 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
2852 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
2853
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002854 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
2855 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
2856 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002857 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002858 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
2859
2860 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
2861
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002862 Example :
2863 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02002864 errorfile 408 /dev/null # workaround Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002865 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
2866 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
2867
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002868
2869errorloc <code> <url>
2870errorloc302 <code> <url>
2871 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2872 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2873 yes | yes | yes | yes
2874 Arguments :
2875 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002876 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002877
2878 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2879 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2880 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2881 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2882 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2883
2884 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2885 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2886 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2887
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002888 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2889
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002890 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
2891 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
2892 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
2893 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
2894 workaround this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
2895 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
2896 request.
2897
2898 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
2899
2900
2901errorloc303 <code> <url>
2902 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2903 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2904 yes | yes | yes | yes
2905 Arguments :
2906 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2907 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2908
2909 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2910 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2911 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2912 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2913 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2914
2915 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2916 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2917 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2918
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002919 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2920
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002921 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
2922 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
2923 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
2924 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002925 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002926
2927 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
2928
2929
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002930email-alert from <emailaddr>
2931 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
2932 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
2933 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2934 yes | yes | yes | yes
2935
2936 Arguments :
2937
2938 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
2939
2940 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
2941 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
2942
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002943 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
2944 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
2945
2946
2947email-alert level <level>
2948 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
2949 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
2950 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2951 yes | yes | yes | yes
2952
2953 Arguments :
2954
2955 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
2956 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
2957 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
2958
2959 By default level is alert
2960
2961 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
2962 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
2963 for the proxy.
2964
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09002965 Alerts are sent when :
2966
2967 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
2968 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
2969 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
2970 is notice or lower
2971 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
2972 and a health check status update occurs
2973
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002974 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
2975 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002976 section 3.6 about mailers.
2977
2978
2979email-alert mailers <mailersect>
2980 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
2981 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2982 yes | yes | yes | yes
2983
2984 Arguments :
2985
2986 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
2987
2988 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
2989 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
2990
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002991 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
2992 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002993
2994
2995email-alert myhostname <hostname>
2996 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
2997 mailers.
2998 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2999 yes | yes | yes | yes
3000
3001 Arguments :
3002
3003 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
3004
3005 By default the systems hostname is used.
3006
3007 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3008 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3009 for the proxy.
3010
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003011 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
3012 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003013
3014
3015email-alert to <emailaddr>
3016 Declare both the recipent address in the envelope and to address in the
3017 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
3018 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3019 yes | yes | yes | yes
3020
3021 Arguments :
3022
3023 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
3024
3025 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3026 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3027
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003028 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003029 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
3030
3031
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003032force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3033 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
3034 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3035 no | yes | yes | yes
3036
3037 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
3038 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
3039 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
3040 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
3041 marked down for maintenance operations.
3042
3043 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3044 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
3045 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
3046 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
3047 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
3048 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
3049 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
3050 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
3051 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
3052
3053 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3054 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
3055 is used.
3056
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003057 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02003058 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003059
3060
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003061fullconn <conns>
3062 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
3063 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3064 yes | no | yes | yes
3065 Arguments :
3066 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
3067 servers use the maximal number of connections.
3068
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003069 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003070 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003071 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003072 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
3073 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
3074 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
3075 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
3076 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003077 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003078
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003079 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
3080 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01003081 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
3082 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
3083 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003084
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003085 Example :
3086 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
3087 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
3088 # connections.
3089 backend dynamic
3090 fullconn 10000
3091 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3092 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3093
3094 See also : "maxconn", "server"
3095
3096
3097grace <time>
3098 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
3099 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01003100 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003101 Arguments :
3102 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
3103 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
3104 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
3105
3106 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
3107 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003108 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003109 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
3110
3111 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
3112 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
3113 simplify it.
3114
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003115
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003116hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003117 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
3118 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3119 yes | no | yes | yes
3120 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003121 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
3122 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003123
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003124 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
3125 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
3126 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
3127 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
3128 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
3129 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
3130 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
3131 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
3132 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
3133 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01003134
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003135 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
3136 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
3137 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
3138 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
3139 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
3140 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
3141 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
3142 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
3143 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
3144 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
3145 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
3146 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
3147 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003148 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
3149 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003150
3151 <function> is the hash function to be used :
3152
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003153 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003154 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
3155 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
3156 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003157 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
3158 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
3159 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003160
3161 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
3162 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003163 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
3164 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
3165 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
3166 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
3167
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01003168 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
3169 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
3170 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
3171 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
3172 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
3173 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
3174 parameter.
3175
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01003176 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
3177 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
3178 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
3179 used on strings.
3180
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003181 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
3182
3183 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
3184 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
3185 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
3186 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
3187 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
3188 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
3189 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
3190 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
3191 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
3192 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
3193 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
3194 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003195
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003196 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
3197 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
3198 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003199
3200 See also : "balance", "server"
3201
3202
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003203http-check disable-on-404
3204 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
3205 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003206 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003207 Arguments : none
3208
3209 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
3210 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
3211 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
3212 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
3213 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
3214 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
3215 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
3216 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003217 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
3218 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
3219 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
3220
3221 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
3222
3223
3224http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003225 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003226 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02003227 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003228 Arguments :
3229 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
3230 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003231 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003232 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
3233 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
3234 details on the supported keywords.
3235
3236 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
3237 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
3238 with the usual backslash ('\').
3239
3240 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
3241 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
3242 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
3243 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
3244 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
3245
3246 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003247 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003248 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
3249 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3250 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3251
3252 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003253 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003254 response's status code matches the expression. If the
3255 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3256 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3257 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
3258
3259 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003260 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003261 response's body contains this exact string. If the
3262 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3263 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
3264 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
3265 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
3266 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
3267 trace).
3268
3269 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003270 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003271 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
3272 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
3273 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
3274 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
3275 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
3276 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
3277
3278 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
3279 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
3280 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
3281 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
3282 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
3283 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
3284 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
3285 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
3286
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01003287 Also "http-check expect" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
3288 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
3289 header should not be present in the request provided by "option httpchk".
3290
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003291 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
3292 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
3293
3294 Examples :
3295 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003296 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003297
3298 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003299 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003300
3301 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003302 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003303
3304 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003305 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*</html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003306
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003307 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003308
3309
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003310http-check send-state
3311 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
3312 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3313 yes | no | yes | yes
3314 Arguments : none
3315
3316 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
3317 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
3318 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
3319 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
3320 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
3321
3322 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
3323 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
3324 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
3325 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
3326 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08003327 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
3328 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
3329 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
3330
3331 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
3332 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
3333 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
3334
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003335 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
3336 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
3337 checked in multiple backends.
3338
3339 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
3340 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
3341
3342 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
3343 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
3344 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
3345 one fails.
3346
3347 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
3348 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
3349 connections on all servers of the same backend.
3350
3351 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
3352 server's queue.
3353
3354 Example of a header received by the application server :
3355 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
3356 scur=13/22; qcur=0
3357
3358 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
3359
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003360http-request { allow | deny | tarpit | auth [realm <realm>] | redirect <rule> |
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003361 add-header <name> <fmt> | set-header <name> <fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003362 capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ] |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003363 del-header <name> | set-nice <nice> | set-log-level <level> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003364 replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
3365 replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01003366 set-method <fmt> | set-path <fmt> | set-query <fmt> |
3367 set-uri <fmt> | set-tos <tos> | set-mark <mark> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003368 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3369 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3370 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
Baptiste Assmannbb7e86a2014-09-03 18:29:47 +02003371 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003372 set-var(<var name>) <expr> |
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003373 { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] |
3374 lua <function name>
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003375 }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003376 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003377 Access control for Layer 7 requests
3378
3379 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3380 no | yes | yes | yes
3381
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003382 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
3383 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
3384 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
3385 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
3386 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003387
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003388 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
3389 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request
3390 pass the check. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
3391
3392 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
3393 the request and emits an HTTP 403 error. No further "http-request" rules
3394 are evaluated.
3395
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003396 - "tarpit" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks
3397 the request without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit"
3398 or "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the
3399 client is still connected, an HTTP error 500 is returned so that the
3400 client does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags
3401 "PT". The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack
3402 when they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
3403 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the
3404 load on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003405 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003406 front firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections.
3407
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003408 - "auth" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds
3409 with an HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid
3410 user name and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An
3411 optional "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm
3412 that is returned with the response (typically the application's name).
3413
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01003414 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
3415 This is exactly the same as the "redirect" statement except that it
3416 inserts a redirect rule which can be processed in the middle of other
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01003417 "http-request" rules and that these rules use the "log-format" strings.
3418 See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax.
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01003419
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003420 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
3421 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
3422 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly
3423 useful to pass connection-specific information to the server (eg: the
3424 client's SSL certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This
3425 rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note
3426 that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
3427 the resulting header from a previous rule.
3428
3429 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
3430 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
3431 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
Willy Tarreau85603282015-01-21 20:39:27 +01003432 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so
3433 it is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003434
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003435 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
3436 <name>.
3437
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003438 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
3439 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
3440 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
3441 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
3442 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
3443 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
3444 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
3445 in their value, such as If-Modified-Since and so on.
3446
3447 Example:
3448
3449 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
3450
3451 applied to:
3452
3453 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3454
3455 outputs:
3456
3457 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3458
3459 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
3460
3461 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
3462 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
3463 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
3464 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
3465 header.
3466
3467 Example:
3468
3469 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
3470
3471 applied to:
3472
3473 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3474
3475 outputs:
3476
3477 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3478
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01003479 - "set-method" rewrites the request method with the result of the
3480 evaluation of format string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons
3481 for having to do so as this is more likely to break something than to fix
3482 it.
3483
3484 - "set-path" rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of
3485 format string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a
3486 scheme and authority is found before the path, they are left intact as
3487 well. If the request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with
3488 the format. This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of
3489 a path for example. See also "set-query" and "set-uri".
3490
3491 Example :
3492 # prepend the host name before the path
3493 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
3494
3495 - "set-query" rewrites the request's query string which appears after the
3496 first question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format
3497 string <fmt>. The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the
3498 request doesn't contain a question mark and the new value is not empty,
3499 then one is added at the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If
3500 a question mark was present, it will never be removed even if the value
3501 is empty. This can be used to add or remove parameters from the query
3502 string. See also "set-query" and "set-uri".
3503
3504 Example :
3505 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
3506 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
3507
3508 - "set-uri" rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of
3509 format string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all
3510 replaced at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies,
3511 or to perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts
3512 between the path and the query string. See also "set-path" and
3513 "set-query".
3514
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003515 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
3516 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
3517 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
3518 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
3519 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
3520 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
3521 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
3522 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
3523
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02003524 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
3525 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
3526 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
3527 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
3528 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
3529 another equipment.
3530
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02003531 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
3532 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
3533 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
3534 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
3535 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
3536 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
3537 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
3538 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
3539
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02003540 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
3541 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
3542 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
3543 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
3544 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
3545 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
3546 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
3547 admin privileges.
3548
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003549 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3550 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3551 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3552 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
3553 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3554 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3555 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
3556 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3557
3558 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3559 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3560 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3561 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3562 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
3563 can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3564
3565 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3566 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3567 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3568 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3569 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
3570 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3571
3572 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3573 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3574 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
3575 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
3576 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
3577 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3578 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3579 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
3580 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3581
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003582 - capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ] :
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02003583 captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts
3584 it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
3585 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear
3586 next to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in
3587 the logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules
3588 to feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
3589 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
3590 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
3591 request header" for more information.
3592
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003593 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store
3594 the captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful
3595 to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous
3596 directive "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
3597
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02003598 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
3599 enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules
3600 do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Three sets of
3601 counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The first
3602 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
3603 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
3604 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
3605 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
3606 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
3607 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
3608 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
3609 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
3610
3611 These actions take one or two arguments :
3612 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
3613 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
3614 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
3615 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
3616
3617 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
3618 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
3619 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
3620 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
3621
3622 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
3623 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
3624 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
3625 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
3626 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
3627 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
3628 been started. As an exception, connection counters and request counters
3629 are systematically updated so that they reflect useful information.
3630
3631 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
3632 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
3633 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
3634 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
3635 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
3636
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003637 - "lua" is used to run a Lua function if the action is executed. The single
3638 parameter is the name of the function to run. The prototype of the
3639 function is documented in the API documentation.
3640
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003641 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr> :
3642 Is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
3643 inline.
3644
3645 <var-name> The name of the variable starts by an indication about its
3646 scope. The allowed scopes are:
3647 "sess" : the variable is shared with all the session,
3648 "txn" : the variable is shared with all the transaction
3649 (request and response)
3650 "req" : the variable is shared only during the request
3651 processing
3652 "res" : the variable is shared only during the response
3653 processing.
3654 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
3655 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
3656 and '_'.
3657
3658 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
3659 followed by some converters.
3660
3661 Example:
3662
3663 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
3664
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003665 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
3666
3667 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
3668 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
3669 rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by
3670 almost all further ACL rules.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003671
3672 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003673 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
3674 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
3675 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003676
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003677 http-request allow if nagios
3678 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
3679 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
3680 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003681
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003682 Example:
3683 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003684 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003685
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003686 Example:
3687 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
3688 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
3689 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id]
3690 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
3691 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
3692 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
3693 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
3694 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
3695 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
3696
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003697 Example:
3698 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
3699 acl add path /addacl
3700 acl del path /delacl
3701
3702 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
3703
3704 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
3705 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
3706
3707 Example:
3708 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
3709 acl setmap path /setmap
3710 acl delmap path /delmap
3711
3712 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
3713
3714 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
3715 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
3716
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02003717 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
3718 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003719
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003720http-response { allow | deny | add-header <name> <fmt> | set-nice <nice> |
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02003721 capture <sample> id <id> | redirect <rule> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003722 set-header <name> <fmt> | del-header <name> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003723 replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
3724 replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003725 set-log-level <level> | set-mark <mark> | set-tos <tos> |
3726 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3727 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3728 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003729 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003730 set-var(<var-name>) <expr> |
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003731 lua <function name>
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003732 }
Lukas Tribus2dd1d1a2013-06-19 23:34:41 +02003733 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003734 Access control for Layer 7 responses
3735
3736 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3737 no | yes | yes | yes
3738
3739 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
3740 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
3741 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
3742 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
3743 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
3744 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
3745
3746 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
3747 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response
3748 pass the check. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the
3749 current section.
3750
3751 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
3752 the response and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response"
3753 rules are evaluated.
3754
3755 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
3756 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
3757 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send
3758 a cookie to a client for example, or to pass some internal information.
3759 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
3760 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might
3761 reuse the resulting header from a previous rule.
3762
3763 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
3764 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
3765 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
3766 external users.
3767
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003768 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
3769 <name>.
3770
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003771 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
3772 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
3773 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
3774 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
3775 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
3776 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
3777 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
3778 in their value, such as Set-Cookie, Expires and so on.
3779
3780 Example:
3781
3782 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
3783
3784 applied to:
3785
3786 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
3787
3788 outputs:
3789
3790 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
3791
3792 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
3793
3794 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
3795 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
3796 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
3797 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
3798 header.
3799
3800 Example:
3801
3802 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
3803
3804 applied to:
3805
3806 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
3807
3808 outputs:
3809
3810 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
3811
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003812 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
3813 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
3814 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
3815 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
3816 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
3817 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
3818 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
3819 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
3820
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02003821 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
3822 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
3823 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
3824 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
3825 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
3826 another equipment.
3827
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02003828 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
3829 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
3830 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
3831 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
3832 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
3833 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
3834 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
3835 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
3836
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02003837 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
3838 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
3839 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
3840 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
3841 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
3842 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
3843 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
3844 admin privileges.
3845
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003846 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3847 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3848 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3849 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
3850 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3851 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3852 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
3853 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3854
3855 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3856 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3857 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3858 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3859 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
3860 can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3861
3862 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3863 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3864 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3865 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3866 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
3867 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3868
3869 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3870 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3871 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
3872 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
3873 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
3874 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3875 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3876 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
3877 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3878
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003879 - "lua" is used to run a Lua function if the action is executed. The single
3880 parameter is the name of the function to run. The prototype of the
3881 function is documented in the API documentation.
3882
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02003883 - capture <sample> id <id> :
3884 captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and converts
3885 it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
3886 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
3887 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
3888 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
3889 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
3890 response header" for more information.
3891
3892 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing
3893 the string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
3894 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by
3895 a previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
3896 keyword.
3897
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02003898 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
3899 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
3900 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible
3901 on the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When
3902 a redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server
3903 are closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
3904
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003905 - set-var(<var-name>) expr:
3906 Is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
3907 inline.
3908
3909 <var-name> The name of the variable starts by an indication about its
3910 scope. The allowed scopes are:
3911 "sess" : the variable is shared with all the session,
3912 "txn" : the variable is shared with all the transaction
3913 (request and response)
3914 "req" : the variable is shared only during the request
3915 processing
3916 "res" : the variable is shared only during the response
3917 processing.
3918 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
3919 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
3920 and '_'.
3921
3922 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
3923 followed by some converters.
3924
3925 Example:
3926
3927 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
3928
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003929 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
3930
Godbach09250262013-07-02 01:19:15 +08003931 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003932 the HTTP processing, before "reqdel" or "reqrep" rules. That way, headers
3933 added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further ACL
3934 rules.
3935
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003936 Example:
3937 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
3938
3939 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
3940
3941 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
3942 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
3943
3944 Example:
3945 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
3946
3947 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
3948
3949 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
3950 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
3951
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003952 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
3953 ACL usage.
3954
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02003955
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05003956http-send-name-header [<header>]
3957 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
3958
3959 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3960 yes | no | yes | yes
3961
3962 Arguments :
3963
3964 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
3965
3966 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
3967 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
3968 is added with the header string proved.
3969
3970 See also : "server"
3971
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01003972id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02003973 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
3974 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3975 no | yes | yes | yes
3976 Arguments : none
3977
3978 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
3979 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
3980 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01003981
3982
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003983ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3984 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
3985 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3986 no | yes | yes | yes
3987
3988 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
3989 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
3990 and running).
3991
3992 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3993 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
3994 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003995 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003996 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
3997
3998 Combined with "appsession", it can also help reduce HAProxy memory usage, as
3999 the appsession table won't grow if persistence is ignored.
4000
4001 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
4002 "unless" condition is met.
4003
4004 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
4005
4006
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004007log global
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02004008log <address> [len <length>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004009no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004010 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
4011 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4012 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004013
4014 Prefix :
4015 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
4016 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
4017 prefix does not allow arguments.
4018
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004019 Arguments :
4020 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
4021 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
4022 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
4023 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
4024 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
4025 parameter.
4026
4027 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
4028 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
4029
4030 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
4031 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
4032 standard syslog port).
4033
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01004034 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
4035 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
4036 standard syslog port).
4037
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004038 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
4039 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
4040 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
4041 appropriately writeable).
4042
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004043 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
4044 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004045
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02004046 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
4047 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
4048 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
4049 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
4050 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
4051 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
4052 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
4053 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
4054 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
4055 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
4056 long captures or JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
4057
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004058 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
4059
4060 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
4061 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
4062 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
4063
4064 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
4065 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
4066 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02004067 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
4068 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
4069 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
4070 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
4071 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004072
4073 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
4074
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004075 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
4076 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
4077 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004078
4079 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
4080 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
4081 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
4082 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
4083
4084 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
4085 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004086
4087 Example :
4088 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02004089 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
4090 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004091 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004092
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004093
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01004094log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01004095 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
4096 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4097 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01004098
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01004099 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
4100 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
4101 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
4102 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
4103 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01004104
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01004105log-tag <string>
4106 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
4107 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4108 yes | yes | yes | yes
4109
4110 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
4111 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
4112 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
4113 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
4114 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
4115 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
4116 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
4117 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
4118 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004119
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02004120max-keep-alive-queue <value>
4121 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
4122 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4123 yes | no | yes | yes
4124
4125 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
4126 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
4127 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
4128 servers.
4129
4130 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
4131 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
4132 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
4133 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
4134 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
4135 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (eg: local static server can
4136 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
4137 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
4138 picking a different server.
4139
4140 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
4141 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
4142 even if they have to be queued.
4143
4144 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
4145 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
4146
4147
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004148maxconn <conns>
4149 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
4150 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4151 yes | yes | yes | no
4152 Arguments :
4153 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
4154 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
4155 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
4156 closes.
4157
4158 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
4159 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
4160 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
4161 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
4162 of 8kB each, as well as some other data resulting in about 17 kB of RAM being
4163 consumed per established connection. That means that a medium system equipped
4164 with 1GB of RAM can withstand around 40000-50000 concurrent connections if
4165 properly tuned.
4166
4167 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
4168 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
4169 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
4170
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02004171 By default, this value is set to 2000.
4172
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004173 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
4174
4175
4176mode { tcp|http|health }
4177 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
4178 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4179 yes | yes | yes | yes
4180 Arguments :
4181 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
4182 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
4183 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
4184 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
4185
4186 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
4187 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
4188 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
4189 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
4190 brings HAProxy most of its value.
4191
4192 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02004193 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
4194 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
4195 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
4196 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
4197 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
4198 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
4199 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004200
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004201 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
4202 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
4203 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004204
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004205 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004206 defaults http_instances
4207 mode http
4208
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004209 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004210
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004211
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01004212monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004213 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004214 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4215 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004216 Arguments :
4217 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
4218 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004219 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004220 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
4221 backend and its backup.
4222
4223 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
4224 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
4225 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
4226 servers in a list of backends.
4227
4228 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
4229 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
4230 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
4231 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
4232 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
4233 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
4234 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004235 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
4236 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004237
4238 Example:
4239 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004240 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004241 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
4242 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
4243 monitor-uri /site_alive
4244 monitor fail if site_dead
4245
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004246 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004247
4248
4249monitor-net <source>
4250 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
4251 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4252 yes | yes | yes | no
4253 Arguments :
4254 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
4255 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
4256 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
4257 followed by a mask.
4258
4259 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
4260 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004261 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004262 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
4263
4264 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
4265 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
4266 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
4267 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02004268 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
4269 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
4270 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004271
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02004272 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
4273 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
4274 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
4275 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
4276 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
4277 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004278
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01004279 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
4280 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004281
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004282 Example :
4283 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
4284 frontend www
4285 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
4286
4287 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
4288
4289
4290monitor-uri <uri>
4291 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
4292 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4293 yes | yes | yes | no
4294 Arguments :
4295 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
4296 health status instead of forwarding the request.
4297
4298 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
4299 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
4300 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
4301 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
4302 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
4303 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
4304 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
4305 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
4306
4307 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
4308 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
4309 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
4310 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
4311 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
4312 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
4313
4314 Example :
4315 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
4316 frontend www
4317 mode http
4318 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
4319
4320 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
4321
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004322
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004323option abortonclose
4324no option abortonclose
4325 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
4326 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4327 yes | no | yes | yes
4328 Arguments : none
4329
4330 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
4331 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
4332 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
4333 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004334 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004335 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
4336 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
4337 encountered while delivering the response.
4338
4339 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
4340 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
4341 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
4342 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
4343 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
4344 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004345 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004346 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004347 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004348 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
4349 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
4350 still not served and not pollute the servers.
4351
4352 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
4353 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
4354 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
4355 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
4356 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
4357 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
4358 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
4359 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004360 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004361
4362 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4363 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4364
4365 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
4366
4367
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004368option accept-invalid-http-request
4369no option accept-invalid-http-request
4370 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
4371 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4372 yes | yes | yes | no
4373 Arguments : none
4374
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02004375 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004376 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
4377 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
4378 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
4379 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
4380 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
4381 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
4382 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01004383 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
4384 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
4385 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
4386 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
4387 not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02004388 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02004389 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
4390 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
4391 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004392
4393 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
4394 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
4395 been confirmed.
4396
4397 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
4398 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01004399 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
4400 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004401 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
4402
4403 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4404 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4405
4406 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
4407 stats socket.
4408
4409
4410option accept-invalid-http-response
4411no option accept-invalid-http-response
4412 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
4413 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4414 yes | no | yes | yes
4415 Arguments : none
4416
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02004417 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004418 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
4419 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
4420 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
4421 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
4422 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
4423 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
4424 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02004425 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
4426 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
4427 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004428
4429 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
4430 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
4431 been confirmed.
4432
4433 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
4434 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
4435 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
4436 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
4437
4438 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4439 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4440
4441 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
4442 stats socket.
4443
4444
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004445option allbackups
4446no option allbackups
4447 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
4448 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4449 yes | no | yes | yes
4450 Arguments : none
4451
4452 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
4453 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
4454 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
4455 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
4456 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
4457 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
4458 order between the backup servers anymore.
4459
4460 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
4461 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
4462
4463 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4464 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4465
4466
4467option checkcache
4468no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08004469 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004470 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4471 yes | no | yes | yes
4472 Arguments : none
4473
4474 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
4475 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004476 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004477 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
4478 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02004479 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004480
4481 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004482 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004483 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004484 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
4485 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004486 to the client are :
4487 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004488 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004489 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004490 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
4491 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
4492 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
4493 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
4494 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
4495 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
4496 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
4497 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
4498 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
4499 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
4500 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
4501
4502 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004503 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004504 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004505 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004506 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
4507
4508 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
4509 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004510 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004511 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
4512
4513 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4514 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4515
4516
4517option clitcpka
4518no option clitcpka
4519 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
4520 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4521 yes | yes | yes | no
4522 Arguments : none
4523
4524 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
4525 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
4526 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
4527 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
4528
4529 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
4530 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
4531 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
4532 operating system and its tuning parameters.
4533
4534 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
4535 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
4536 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
4537 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
4538 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
4539
4540 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
4541
4542 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
4543 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
4544 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
4545
4546 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4547 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4548
4549 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
4550
4551
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004552option contstats
4553 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
4554 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4555 yes | yes | yes | no
4556 Arguments : none
4557
4558 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
4559 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
4560 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
4561 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
4562 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented continuously,
4563 during a whole session. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so
4564 it is not enabled by default, as it has small performance impact (~0.5%).
4565
4566
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004567option dontlog-normal
4568no option dontlog-normal
4569 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
4570 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4571 yes | yes | yes | no
4572 Arguments : none
4573
4574 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
4575 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
4576 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
4577 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
4578 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
4579 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
4580 logged.
4581
4582 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
4583 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
4584 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
4585
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004586 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004587 logging.
4588
4589
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004590option dontlognull
4591no option dontlognull
4592 Enable or disable logging of null connections
4593 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4594 yes | yes | yes | no
4595 Arguments : none
4596
4597 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
4598 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
4599 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
4600 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
4601 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
4602 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02004603 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
4604 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
4605 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004606
4607 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
4608 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
4609 would not be logged.
4610
4611 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4612 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4613
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02004614 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
4615 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004616
4617
4618option forceclose
4619no option forceclose
4620 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
4621 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01004622 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004623 Arguments : none
4624
4625 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
4626 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
4627 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
4628 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
4629 global session times in the logs.
4630
4631 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01004632 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004633 to respond and release some resources earlier than with "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004634
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004635 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
4636 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
4637 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
4638
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004639 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
4640 http-server-close", "option http-keep-alive", or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004641
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004642 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4643 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4644
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004645 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004646
4647
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004648option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004649 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
4650 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4651 yes | yes | yes | yes
4652 Arguments :
4653 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
4654 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004655 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004656 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004657
4658 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
4659 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
4660 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
4661 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
4662 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
4663 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
4664 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004665 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
4666 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
4667 possible that the client has already brought one.
4668
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004669 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004670 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004671 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
4672 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004673 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
4674 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004675
4676 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
4677 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
4678 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
4679 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
4680 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
4681 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
4682 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
4683
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004684 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
4685 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
4686 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
4687 are under the control of the end-user.
4688
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004689 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004690 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
4691 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004692 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
4693 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
4694 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004695
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004696 Examples :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004697 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
4698 frontend www
4699 mode http
4700 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
4701
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004702 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
4703 backend www
4704 mode http
4705 option forwardfor header X-Client
4706
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004707 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004708 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004709
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004710
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02004711option http-buffer-request
4712no option http-buffer-request
4713 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
4714 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4715 yes | yes | yes | yes
4716 Arguments : none
4717
4718 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
4719 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
4720 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
4721 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
4722 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
4723 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
4724 body is received, or the request buffer is full, or the first chunk is
4725 complete in case of chunked encoding. It can have undesired side effects with
4726 some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbufferred transmissions between
4727 the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely not be used by
4728 default.
4729
4730 See also : "option http-no-delay"
4731
4732
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02004733option http-ignore-probes
4734no option http-ignore-probes
4735 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
4736 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4737 yes | yes | yes | no
4738 Arguments : none
4739
4740 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
4741 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
4742 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
4743 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
4744 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
4745 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
4746 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
4747 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
4748 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
4749 was received over a connection before it was closed ;
4750 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation ;
4751 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
4752
4753 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
4754 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
4755 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
4756 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
4757 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
4758 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
4759 are often the only way to detect them.
4760
4761 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4762 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4763
4764 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
4765
4766
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004767option http-keep-alive
4768no option http-keep-alive
4769 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
4770 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4771 yes | yes | yes | yes
4772 Arguments : none
4773
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004774 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4775 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4776 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
4777 start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such as
4778 "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4779 "option http-tunnel". This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode,
4780 which can be useful when another mode was used in a defaults section.
4781
4782 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
4783 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004784 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
4785 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
4786 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
4787 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
4788 situations where this option may be useful :
4789
4790 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
4791 instead of requests (eg: NTLM authentication)
4792
4793 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
4794 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
4795
4796 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
4797 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
4798 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
4799 request.
4800
4801 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
4802 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004803 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
4804 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
4805 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004806
4807 In general it is preferred to use "option http-server-close" with application
4808 servers, and some static servers might benefit from "option http-keep-alive".
4809
4810 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
4811 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
4812 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
4813 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
4814 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
4815 not set.
4816
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004817 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
4818 http-server-close", "option forceclose" or "option http-tunnel". When backend
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004819 and frontend options differ, all of these 4 options have precedence over
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004820 "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004821
4822 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004823 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
4824 "option httpclose", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004825
4826
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02004827option http-no-delay
4828no option http-no-delay
4829 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
4830 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4831 yes | yes | yes | yes
4832 Arguments : none
4833
4834 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
4835 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
4836 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
4837 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
4838 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
4839 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
4840 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
4841 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
4842 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
4843 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
4844 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
4845 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
4846 affected.
4847
4848 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
4849 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
4850 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
4851 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
4852 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
4853 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
4854 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
4855 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
4856 latency environments.
4857
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02004858 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
4859
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02004860
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004861option http-pretend-keepalive
4862no option http-pretend-keepalive
4863 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
4864 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4865 yes | yes | yes | yes
4866 Arguments : none
4867
4868 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
4869 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
4870 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
4871 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
4872 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
4873 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
4874 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
4875 consider the response complete.
4876
4877 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
4878 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
4879 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
4880 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
4881 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
4882 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
4883
4884 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
4885 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
4886 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
4887 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
4888 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
4889 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
4890 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
4891
4892 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4893 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004894 This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will cause
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02004895 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
4896 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004897
4898 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4899 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4900
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004901 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close", and
4902 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004903
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004904
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004905option http-server-close
4906no option http-server-close
4907 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
4908 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4909 yes | yes | yes | yes
4910 Arguments : none
4911
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004912 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4913 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4914 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4915 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
4916 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4917 "option http-tunnel". Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP
4918 connection-close mode on the server side while keeping the ability to support
4919 HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest
4920 latency on the client side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on
4921 the server side to save server resources, similarly to "option forceclose".
4922 It also permits non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode
4923 to the clients if they conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note
4924 that some servers do not always conform to those requirements when they see
4925 "Connection: close" in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will
4926 never be used. A workaround consists in enabling "option
4927 http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004928
4929 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
4930 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
4931 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
4932 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01004933 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
4934 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004935
4936 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4937 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004938 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option forceclose",
4939 "option http-tunnel" or "option http-keep-alive". Please check section 4
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004940 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when frontend and
4941 backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004942
4943 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4944 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4945
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02004946 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004947 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
4948 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004949
4950
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004951option http-tunnel
4952no option http-tunnel
4953 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction
4954 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4955 yes | yes | yes | yes
4956 Arguments : none
4957
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004958 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4959 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4960 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4961 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
4962 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4963 "option http-tunnel".
4964
4965 Option "http-tunnel" disables any HTTP processing past the first request and
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004966 the first response. This is the mode which was used by default in versions
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004967 1.0 to 1.5-dev21. It is the mode with the lowest processing overhead, which
4968 is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific cases such as when
4969 using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is not compatible, or
4970 just to log one request per client in order to reduce log size. Note that
4971 everything which works at the HTTP level, including header parsing/addition,
4972 cookie processing or content switching will only work for the first request
4973 and will be ignored after the first response.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004974
4975 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4976 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4977
4978 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
4979 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
4980 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
4981
4982
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004983option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01004984no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004985 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
4986 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4987 yes | yes | yes | no
4988 Arguments : none
4989
4990 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
4991 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
4992 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
4993 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
4994 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
4995 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
4996 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
4997
4998 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
4999 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
5000 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. The
5001 choice of header only affects requests passing through proxies making use of
5002 one of the "httpclose", "forceclose" and "http-server-close" options. Note
5003 that this option can only be specified in a frontend and will affect the
5004 request along its whole life.
5005
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01005006 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
5007 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
5008 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
5009 front of an existing proxy.
5010
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005011 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
5012
5013 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
5014 http-server-close".
5015
5016
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005017option httpchk
5018option httpchk <uri>
5019option httpchk <method> <uri>
5020option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
5021 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
5022 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5023 yes | no | yes | yes
5024 Arguments :
5025 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
5026 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
5027 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
5028 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
5029 ones.
5030
5031 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
5032 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
5033 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
5034
5035 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
5036 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
5037 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
5038 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
5039 after "\r\n" following the version string.
5040
5041 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
5042 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
5043 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
5044 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
5045 the lack of any response.
5046
5047 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
5048
5049 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
5050 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
5051 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
5052
5053 Examples :
5054 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
5055 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
5056 backend https_relay
5057 mode tcp
5058 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
5059 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
5060
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09005061 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
5062 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
5063 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005064
5065
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005066option httpclose
5067no option httpclose
5068 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
5069 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5070 yes | yes | yes | yes
5071 Arguments : none
5072
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005073 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5074 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5075 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5076 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005077 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005078 "option http-tunnel".
5079
5080 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will work in HTTP tunnel mode and check
5081 if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction, and will
5082 add one if missing. Each end should react to this by actively closing the TCP
5083 connection after each transfer, thus resulting in a switch to the HTTP close
5084 mode. Any "Connection" header different from "close" will also be removed.
5085 Note that this option is deprecated since what it does is very cheap but not
5086 reliable. Using "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose" is strongly
5087 recommended instead.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005088
5089 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005090 close the connection even though they reply "Connection: close". For this
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01005091 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
5092 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
5093 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
5094 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
5095 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005096
5097 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
5098 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005099 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close",
5100 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive" or "option http-tunnel". Please
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005101 check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when
5102 frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005103
5104 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5105 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5106
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02005107 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
5108 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005109
5110
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02005111option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005112 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
5113 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5114 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02005115 Arguments :
5116 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
5117 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
5118 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
5119 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
5120 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005121
5122 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
5123 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
5124 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
5125 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
5126 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
5127 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
5128 ports.
5129
5130 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
5131
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01005132 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
5133 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02005134
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005135 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005136
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005137
5138option http_proxy
5139no option http_proxy
5140 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
5141 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5142 yes | yes | yes | yes
5143 Arguments : none
5144
5145 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
5146 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
5147 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
5148 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
5149 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
5150
5151 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
5152 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
5153 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. Last,
5154 if the clients are susceptible of sending keep-alive requests, it will be
Cyril Bonté2409e682010-12-14 22:47:51 +01005155 needed to add "option httpclose" to ensure that all requests will correctly
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005156 be analyzed.
5157
5158 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5159 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5160
5161 Example :
5162 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
5163 backend direct_forward
5164 option httpclose
5165 option http_proxy
5166
5167 See also : "option httpclose"
5168
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005169
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005170option independent-streams
5171no option independent-streams
5172 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02005173 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5174 yes | yes | yes | yes
5175 Arguments : none
5176
5177 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
5178 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
5179 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
5180 receive data or not.
5181
5182 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
5183 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
5184 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
5185 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
5186 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
5187 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
5188 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
5189 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
5190 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
5191 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
5192 socket buffers.
5193
5194 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
5195 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
5196 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
5197 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
5198 slow lines, so use it with caution.
5199
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005200 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independent-streams"
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005201 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
5202 deprecated.
5203
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02005204 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02005205
5206
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02005207option ldap-check
5208 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
5209 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5210 yes | no | yes | yes
5211 Arguments : none
5212
5213 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
5214 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
5215 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
5216 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
5217
5218 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
5219 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
5220
5221 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
5222 configure it.
5223
5224 Example :
5225 option ldap-check
5226
5227 See also : "option httpchk"
5228
5229
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09005230option external-check
5231 Use external processes for server health checks
5232 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5233 yes | no | yes | yes
5234
5235 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
5236 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
5237 command".
5238
5239 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
5240
5241 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
5242
5243
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005244option log-health-checks
5245no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005246 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005247 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5248 yes | no | yes | yes
5249 Arguments : none
5250
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005251 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
5252 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
5253 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005254
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005255 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
5256 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
5257 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
5258 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
5259 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
5260
5261 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (eg: enable/disable on
5262 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005263
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005264 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
5265 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
5266 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005267
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005268
5269option log-separate-errors
5270no option log-separate-errors
5271 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
5272 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5273 yes | yes | yes | no
5274 Arguments : none
5275
5276 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
5277 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
5278 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
5279 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
5280 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
5281 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
5282 provides very important information.
5283
5284 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
5285 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
5286 error logs.
5287
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005288 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005289 logging.
5290
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005291
5292option logasap
5293no option logasap
5294 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
5295 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5296 yes | yes | yes | no
5297 Arguments : none
5298
5299 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
5300 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
5301 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
5302 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
5303 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
5304 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
5305 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005306 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005307 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
5308 bytes are expected to be transferred.
5309
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01005310 Examples :
5311 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
5312 mode http
5313 option httplog
5314 option logasap
5315 log 192.168.2.200 local3
5316
5317 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
5318 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
5319 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
5320 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
5321
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005322 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005323 logging.
5324
5325
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02005326option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02005327 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01005328 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5329 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02005330 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005331 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
5332 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02005333 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02005334
5335 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
5336 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
5337 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
5338 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
5339 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
5340 in the MySQL table, like this :
5341
5342 USE mysql;
5343 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
5344 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
5345
5346 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
5347 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
5348 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
5349 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
5350 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
5351 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
5352 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
5353 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
5354 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
5355
5356 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
5357 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01005358
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02005359 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01005360
5361 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
5362 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
5363 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
5364 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
5365 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL server
5366 to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
5367
5368 See also: "option httpchk"
5369
5370
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005371option nolinger
5372no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005373 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005374 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5375 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005376 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005377
5378 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
5379 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
5380 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
5381 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
5382 connections.
5383
5384 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
5385 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
5386 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
5387 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
5388 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
5389 this too.
5390
5391 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
5392 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
5393 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
5394
5395 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
5396 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
5397 for servers.
5398
5399 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5400 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5401
5402
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005403option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
5404 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
5405 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5406 yes | yes | yes | yes
5407 Arguments :
5408 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
5409 matching <network>
5410 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
5411 header name.
5412
5413 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
5414 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
5415 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
5416 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
5417 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
5418 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
5419 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
5420 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
5421 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
5422 possible that the client has already brought one.
5423
5424 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
5425 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
5426 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
5427 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
5428 header and requires different one.
5429
5430 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
5431 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
5432 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
5433 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
5434 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
5435 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
5436 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
5437
5438 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
5439 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
5440 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
5441 both are defined.
5442
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005443 Examples :
5444 # Original Destination address
5445 frontend www
5446 mode http
5447 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
5448
5449 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
5450 backend www
5451 mode http
5452 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
5453
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005454 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
5455 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005456
5457
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005458option persist
5459no option persist
5460 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
5461 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5462 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005463 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005464
5465 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
5466 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
5467 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
5468 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
5469 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
5470 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
5471 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
5472 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
5473 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
5474 redirected to another valid server.
5475
5476 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5477 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5478
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005479 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005480
5481
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01005482option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
5483 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
5484 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5485 yes | no | yes | yes
5486 Arguments :
5487 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
5488 PostgreSQL server.
5489
5490 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
5491 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
5492 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
5493 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
5494
5495 See also: "option httpchk"
5496
5497
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005498option prefer-last-server
5499no option prefer-last-server
5500 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
5501 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5502 yes | no | yes | yes
5503 Arguments : none
5504
5505 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
5506 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
5507 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
5508 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
5509 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
5510 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
5511 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
5512 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
5513 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01005514 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
5515 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
5516 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required). This is mandatory for
5517 use with the broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
5518 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
5519 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
5520 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005521
5522 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5523 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5524
5525 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
5526
5527
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005528option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07005529option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005530no option redispatch
5531 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
5532 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5533 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07005534 Arguments :
5535 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
5536 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
5537 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
5538 N indicate a redispath is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
5539 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
5540 historical behaviour of redispatching on the last retry, a
5541 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
5542 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
5543 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
5544
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005545
5546 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
5547 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
5548 be able to access the service anymore.
5549
5550 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
5551 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
5552
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07005553 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005554 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
5555 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005556
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005557 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
5558 "redisp" keywords.
5559
5560 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5561 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5562
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005563 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005564
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005565
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02005566option redis-check
5567 Use redis health checks for server testing
5568 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5569 yes | no | yes | yes
5570 Arguments : none
5571
5572 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
5573 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
5574 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
5575 find the "+PONG" response message.
5576
5577 Example :
5578 option redis-check
5579
5580 See also : "option httpchk"
5581
5582
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005583option smtpchk
5584option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
5585 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
5586 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5587 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005588 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005589 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
5590 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
5591 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
5592
5593 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
5594 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
5595 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
5596
5597 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
5598 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
5599 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
5600 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
5601 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
5602 dead server.
5603
5604 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
5605 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
5606 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
5607 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
5608
5609 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
5610 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
5611 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
5612 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
5613 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in.
5614
5615 Example :
5616 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
5617
5618 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
5619
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005620
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02005621option socket-stats
5622no option socket-stats
5623
5624 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
5625 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5626 yes | yes | yes | no
5627
5628 Arguments : none
5629
5630
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01005631option splice-auto
5632no option splice-auto
5633 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
5634 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5635 yes | yes | yes | yes
5636 Arguments : none
5637
5638 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
5639 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
5640 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
5641 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005642 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01005643 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
5644 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
5645 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
5646 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
5647
5648 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
5649 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
5650 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
5651 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
5652 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
5653 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
5654 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
5655 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
5656 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
5657 keyword.
5658
5659 Example :
5660 option splice-auto
5661
5662 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5663 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5664
5665 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
5666 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
5667
5668
5669option splice-request
5670no option splice-request
5671 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
5672 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5673 yes | yes | yes | yes
5674 Arguments : none
5675
5676 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005677 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01005678 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
5679 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
5680 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
5681 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
5682
5683 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
5684
5685 Example :
5686 option splice-request
5687
5688 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5689 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5690
5691 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
5692 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
5693
5694
5695option splice-response
5696no option splice-response
5697 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
5698 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5699 yes | yes | yes | yes
5700 Arguments : none
5701
5702 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005703 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01005704 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
5705 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
5706 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
5707 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
5708
5709 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
5710
5711 Example :
5712 option splice-response
5713
5714 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5715 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5716
5717 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
5718 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
5719
5720
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005721option srvtcpka
5722no option srvtcpka
5723 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
5724 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5725 yes | no | yes | yes
5726 Arguments : none
5727
5728 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5729 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
5730 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
5731 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5732
5733 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5734 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5735 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5736 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5737
5738 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5739 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5740 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5741 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5742 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5743
5744 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5745
5746 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
5747 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
5748 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
5749
5750 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5751 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5752
5753 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
5754
5755
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005756option ssl-hello-chk
5757 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
5758 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5759 yes | no | yes | yes
5760 Arguments : none
5761
5762 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
5763 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
5764 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
5765 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
5766 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
5767 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
5768 hello message.
5769
5770 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
5771 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
5772 messages, which is appreciable.
5773
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02005774 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
5775 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
5776 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005777
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02005778 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
5779
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005780
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005781option tcp-check
5782 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
5783 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5784 yes | no | yes | yes
5785
5786 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
5787 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
5788
5789 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
5790 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
5791 attempt, which remains the default mode.
5792
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005793 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005794 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
5795 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
5796 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
5797 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
5798 only.
5799
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005800 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005801 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
5802 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
5803 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
5804 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
5805
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005806 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005807 used to test a hello-type protocol. Haproxy sends a message, the server
5808 responds and its response is analysed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005809 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005810 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
5811 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
5812 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
5813 the respective protocols.
5814 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
5815 analysed.
5816
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02005817 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the
5818 script.
5819
5820 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
5821 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr
5822 in debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting.
5823 The "comment" is of course optional.
5824
5825
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005826 Examples :
5827 # perform a POP check (analyse only server's banner)
5828 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02005829 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005830
5831 # perform an IMAP check (analyse only server's banner)
5832 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02005833 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005834
5835 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
5836 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005837 # (send a command then analyse the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005838 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02005839 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005840 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02005841 tcp-check expect +PONGe
5842 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005843 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
5844 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02005845 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005846 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
5847 tcp-check expect string +OK
5848
5849 forge a HTTP request, then analyse the response
5850 (send many headers before analyzing)
5851 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02005852 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005853 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
5854 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
5855 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
5856 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02005857 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005858
5859
5860 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
5861
5862
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02005863option tcp-smart-accept
5864no option tcp-smart-accept
5865 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
5866 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5867 yes | yes | yes | no
5868 Arguments : none
5869
5870 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
5871 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
5872 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
5873 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
5874 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
5875 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
5876
5877 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
5878 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
5879 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
5880 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
5881
5882 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
5883 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
5884 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
5885 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
5886
5887 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
5888 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
5889 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
5890
5891 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
5892 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
5893 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
5894
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02005895 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
5896
5897
5898option tcp-smart-connect
5899no option tcp-smart-connect
5900 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
5901 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5902 yes | no | yes | yes
5903 Arguments : none
5904
5905 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
5906 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
5907 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
5908 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
5909 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
5910
5911 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
5912 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
5913 complex.
5914
5915 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
5916 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
5917 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
5918
5919 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5920 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5921
5922 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
5923
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02005924
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005925option tcpka
5926 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
5927 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5928 yes | yes | yes | yes
5929 Arguments : none
5930
5931 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5932 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
5933 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
5934 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5935
5936 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5937 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5938 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5939 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5940
5941 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5942 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5943 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5944 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5945 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5946
5947 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5948
5949 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
5950 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
5951 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
5952 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
5953 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
5954 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
5955 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
5956 backends.
5957
5958 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
5959
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005960
5961option tcplog
5962 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
5963 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5964 yes | yes | yes | yes
5965 Arguments : none
5966
5967 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
5968 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
5969 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
5970 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
5971 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
5972 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
5973 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
5974 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
5975
5976 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
5977
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005978 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005979
5980
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005981option transparent
5982no option transparent
5983 Enable client-side transparent proxying
5984 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01005985 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005986 Arguments : none
5987
5988 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
5989 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
5990 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
5991 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
5992 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
5993 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
5994 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
5995 appropriate server.
5996
5997 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
5998 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
5999
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01006000 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006001 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006002
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006003
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006004external-check command <command>
6005 Executable to run when performing an external-check
6006 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6007 yes | no | yes | yes
6008
6009 Arguments :
6010 <command> is the external command to run
6011
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006012 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
6013
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01006014 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006015
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01006016 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
6017 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
6018 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
6019 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
6020 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
6021 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006022
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01006023 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
6024
6025 Environment variables :
6026 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
6027 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
6028
6029 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
6030
6031 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
6032
6033 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
6034 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
6035 for a UNIX socket).
6036
6037 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
6038
6039 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
6040
6041 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
6042
6043 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
6044
6045 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
6046
6047 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
6048 socket).
6049
6050 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
6051 the command may be set using "external-check path".
6052
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006053 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
6054 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
6055 failed.
6056
6057 Example :
6058 external-check command /bin/true
6059
6060 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
6061
6062
6063external-check path <path>
6064 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
6065 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6066 yes | no | yes | yes
6067
6068 Arguments :
6069 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
6070
6071 The default path is "".
6072
6073 Example :
6074 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
6075
6076 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
6077 "external-check command"
6078
6079
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006080persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02006081persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006082 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
6083 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6084 yes | no | yes | yes
6085 Arguments :
6086 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02006087 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
6088 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006089
6090 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
6091 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
6092 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
6093 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
6094 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
6095 forwarded to this server.
6096
6097 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
6098 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
6099 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006100 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006101 a single "listen" section.
6102
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02006103 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
6104 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
6105 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
6106
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006107 Example :
6108 listen tse-farm
6109 bind :3389
6110 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
6111 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
6112 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
6113 # apply RDP cookie persistence
6114 persist rdp-cookie
6115 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006116 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006117 balance rdp-cookie
6118 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
6119 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
6120
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09006121 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
6122 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006123
6124
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01006125rate-limit sessions <rate>
6126 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
6127 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6128 yes | yes | yes | no
6129 Arguments :
6130 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
6131 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
6132
6133 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
6134 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
6135 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
6136 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
6137 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
6138 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
6139
6140 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
6141 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
6142 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
6143 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
6144
6145 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
6146 listen smtp
6147 mode tcp
6148 bind :25
6149 rate-limit sessions 10
6150 server 127.0.0.1:1025
6151
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02006152 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
6153 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
6154 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01006155
6156 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
6157
6158
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006159redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6160redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6161redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006162 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
6163 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6164 no | yes | yes | yes
6165
6166 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01006167 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006168
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006169 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006170 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006171 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
6172 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
6173 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006174
6175 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
6176 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
6177 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
6178 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
6179 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006180 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
6181 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
6182 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
6183 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006184
6185 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
6186 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
6187 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
6188 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
6189 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
6190 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006191 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006192 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006193 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
6194 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
6195 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006196
6197 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01006198 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
6199 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
6200 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
6201 means "Moved permanently" and means that the browser should not
6202 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
6203 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
6204 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
6205 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006206
6207 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
6208 expected behaviour of a redirection :
6209
6210 - "drop-query"
6211 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
6212 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
6213 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
6214 with a location-type redirect.
6215
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01006216 - "append-slash"
6217 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
6218 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
6219 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
6220 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
6221
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006222 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
6223 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
6224 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
6225 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
6226 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
6227 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
6228 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
6229
6230 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
6231 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
6232 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
6233 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
6234 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
6235 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
6236 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006237
6238 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
6239 acl clear dst_port 80
6240 acl secure dst_port 8080
6241 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006242 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01006243 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006244 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
6245
6246 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01006247 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
6248 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
6249 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006250 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006251
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01006252 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
6253 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
6254 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
6255
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006256 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01006257 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006258
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006259 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
6260 http-request redirect code 301 location www.%[hdr(host)]%[req.uri] \
6261 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
6262
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006263 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006264
6265
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006266redisp (deprecated)
6267redispatch (deprecated)
6268 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
6269 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6270 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006271 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006272
6273 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
6274 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
6275 be able to access the service anymore.
6276
6277 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
6278 redistribute them to a working server.
6279
6280 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
6281 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
6282 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006283
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006284 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
6285 "option redispatch" instead.
6286
6287 See also : "option redispatch"
6288
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006289
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01006290reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006291 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
6292 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6293 no | yes | yes | yes
6294 Arguments :
6295 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
6296 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006297 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006298
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01006299 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6300 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6301
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006302 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
6303 the last header of an HTTP request.
6304
6305 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6306 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6307 responses.
6308
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01006309 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
6310 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
6311 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
6312
6313 See also: "rspadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
6314 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006315
6316
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006317reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6318reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006319 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
6320 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6321 no | yes | yes | yes
6322 Arguments :
6323 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6324 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6325 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6326 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6327 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
6328 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
6329 ignores case.
6330
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006331 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6332 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6333
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006334 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
6335 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
6336 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
6337 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006338 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006339
6340 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
6341 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
6342
6343 Example :
6344 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
6345 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
6346 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
6347
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006348 See also: "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and
6349 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006350
6351
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006352reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6353reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006354 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
6355 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6356 no | yes | yes | yes
6357 Arguments :
6358 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6359 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6360 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6361 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6362 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
6363 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
6364
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006365 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6366 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6367
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006368 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
6369 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
6370 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
6371 next servers.
6372
6373 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6374 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6375 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
6376
6377 Example :
6378 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
6379 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
6380 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
6381
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006382 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", section 6 about HTTP header
6383 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006384
6385
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006386reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6387reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006388 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
6389 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6390 no | yes | yes | yes
6391 Arguments :
6392 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6393 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6394 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6395 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6396 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
6397 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
6398 case.
6399
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006400 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6401 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6402
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006403 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
6404 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
6405 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
6406 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006407 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006408
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01006409 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006410 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006411 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01006412
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006413 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
6414 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
6415
6416 Example :
6417 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
6418 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
6419 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
6420
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006421 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
6422 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006423
6424
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006425reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6426reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006427 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
6428 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6429 no | yes | yes | yes
6430 Arguments :
6431 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6432 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6433 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6434 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6435 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
6436 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
6437 case.
6438
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006439 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6440 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6441
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006442 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
6443 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
6444 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
6445 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
6446
6447 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
6448 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
6449
6450 Example :
6451 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
6452 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
6453 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
6454 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
6455
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006456 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
6457 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006458
6459
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006460reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6461reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006462 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
6463 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6464 no | yes | yes | yes
6465 Arguments :
6466 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6467 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6468 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6469 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6470 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
6471 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
6472
6473 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
6474 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
6475 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
6476 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006477 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006478
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006479 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6480 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6481
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006482 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
6483 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
6484 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
6485
6486 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6487 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6488 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
6489 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
6490 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
6491
6492 Example :
6493 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006494 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006495 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
6496 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
6497
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04006498 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", section 6 about
6499 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006500
6501
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006502reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6503reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006504 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
6505 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6506 no | yes | yes | yes
6507 Arguments :
6508 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6509 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6510 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6511 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6512 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
6513 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
6514 ignores case.
6515
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006516 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6517 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6518
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006519 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
6520 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01006521 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
6522 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
6523 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006524 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
6525 not set.
6526
6527 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
6528 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
6529 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
6530 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
6531 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
6532
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006533 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006534 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
6535 # block all others.
6536 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
6537 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
6538
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006539 # block bad guys
6540 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
6541 reqitarpit . if badguys
6542
6543 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", section 6 about HTTP header
6544 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006545
6546
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02006547retries <value>
6548 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
6549 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6550 yes | no | yes | yes
6551 Arguments :
6552 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
6553 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
6554 default value is 3.
6555
6556 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
6557 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
6558 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
6559
6560 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006561 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
6562 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02006563
6564 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
6565 server even if a cookie references a different server.
6566
6567 See also : "option redispatch"
6568
6569
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006570rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006571 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
6572 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6573 no | yes | yes | yes
6574 Arguments :
6575 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
6576 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006577 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006578
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006579 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6580 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6581
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006582 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
6583 the last header of an HTTP response.
6584
6585 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6586 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6587 responses.
6588
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006589 See also: "reqadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
6590 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006591
6592
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006593rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6594rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006595 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
6596 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6597 no | yes | yes | yes
6598 Arguments :
6599 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6600 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
6601 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
6602 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
6603 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
6604 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
6605 ignores case.
6606
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006607 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6608 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6609
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006610 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
6611 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02006612 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006613 client.
6614
6615 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6616 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6617 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
6618
6619 Example :
6620 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02006621 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006622
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006623 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", section 6 about HTTP header
6624 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006625
6626
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006627rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6628rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006629 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
6630 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6631 no | yes | yes | yes
6632 Arguments :
6633 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6634 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
6635 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
6636 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
6637 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
6638 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
6639 ignores case.
6640
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006641 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6642 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6643
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006644 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
6645 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
6646 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
6647 case-sensitive.
6648
6649 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01006650 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
6651 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
6652 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006653
6654 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
6655 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
6656
6657 Example :
6658 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
6659 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
6660
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006661 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation
6662 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006663
6664
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006665rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6666rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006667 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
6668 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6669 no | yes | yes | yes
6670 Arguments :
6671 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6672 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
6673 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
6674 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
6675 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
6676 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
6677 ignores case.
6678
6679 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
6680 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
6681 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
6682 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006683 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006684
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006685 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6686 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6687
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006688 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
6689 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
6690 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
6691
6692 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6693 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6694 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
6695 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
6696 are not case-sensitive.
6697
6698 Example :
6699 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
6700 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
6701
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006702 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", section 6 about HTTP header
6703 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006704
6705
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01006706server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006707 Declare a server in a backend
6708 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6709 no | no | yes | yes
6710 Arguments :
6711 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Cyril Bonté941a0c62012-10-15 19:44:24 +02006712 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006713 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006714
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01006715 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
6716 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
6717 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
6718 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02006719 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
6720 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
6721 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
6722 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
6723 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01006724 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
6725 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
6726 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
6727 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
6728 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
6729 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
6730 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02006731 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02006732 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
6733 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
6734 variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006735
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006736 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006737 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
6738 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
6739 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
6740 adding this value to the client's port.
6741
6742 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
6743 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006744 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006745
6746 Examples :
6747 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
6748 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01006749 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02006750 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
6751 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
6752 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006753
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006754 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
6755 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006756
6757
6758source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006759source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01006760source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006761 Set the source address for outgoing connections
6762 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6763 yes | no | yes | yes
6764 Arguments :
6765 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
6766 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01006767
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006768 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01006769 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
6770 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
6771 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
6772 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
6773 supported prefixes are :
6774 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
6775 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
6776 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02006777 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02006778 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
6779 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006780
6781 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
6782 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02006783 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
6784 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
6785 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006786
6787 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
6788 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
6789 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
6790 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
6791 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
6792 <addr>.
6793
6794 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
6795 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
6796 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
6797 port.
6798
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006799 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
6800 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
6801 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
6802 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01006803 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006804 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
6805 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
6806 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
6807 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
6808 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
6809 HTTP header.
6810
6811 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
6812 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006813 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006814 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
6815 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
6816 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
6817 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
6818 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
6819 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
6820 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
6821
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01006822 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
6823 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
6824 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
6825 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
6826 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
6827 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
6828
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006829 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
6830 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
6831 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
6832 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
6833
6834 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
6835 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
6836 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
6837 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
6838 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
6839 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
6840
6841 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
6842 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
6843 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
6844 there are two methods :
6845
6846 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
6847 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
6848 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
6849 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
6850 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
6851 of the client ranges may be used.
6852
6853 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
6854 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
6855 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
6856 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
6857 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
6858 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
6859 same session.
6860
6861 Note that depending on the transparent proxy technology used, it may be
6862 required to force the source address. In fact, cttproxy version 2 requires an
6863 IP address in <addr> above, and does not support setting of "0.0.0.0" as the
6864 IP address because it creates NAT entries which much match the exact outgoing
6865 address. Tproxy version 4 and some other kernel patches which work in pure
6866 forwarding mode generally will not have this limitation.
6867
6868 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
6869 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
6870 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006871 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006872
6873 Examples :
6874 backend private
6875 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
6876 source 192.168.1.200
6877
6878 backend transparent_ssl1
6879 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
6880 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
6881
6882 backend transparent_ssl2
6883 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
6884 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
6885 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
6886
6887 backend transparent_ssl3
6888 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
6889 # is more conntrack-friendly.
6890 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
6891
6892 backend transparent_smtp
6893 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
6894 # with Tproxy version 4.
6895 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
6896
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006897 backend transparent_http
6898 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
6899 # proxy.
6900 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
6901
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006902 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006903 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
6904
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006905
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006906srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6907 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
6908 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6909 yes | no | yes | yes
6910 Arguments :
6911 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6912 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6913 as explained at the top of this document.
6914
6915 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
6916 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
6917 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
6918 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
6919 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
6920 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
6921 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
6922
6923 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6924 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6925 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
6926 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
6927 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006928 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006929 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006930 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006931
6932 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6933 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6934 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6935 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6936 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
6937 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6938
6939 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
6940 Please use "timeout server" instead.
6941
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006942 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
6943 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006944
6945
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006946stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
6947 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
6948 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006949 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006950
6951 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
6952 matched.
6953
6954 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
6955 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
6956
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006957 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6958 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6959 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6960
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01006961 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
6962 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
6963 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
6964 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006965
6966 Example :
6967 # statistics admin level only for localhost
6968 backend stats_localhost
6969 stats enable
6970 stats admin if LOCALHOST
6971
6972 Example :
6973 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
6974 backend stats_auth
6975 stats enable
6976 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
6977 stats admin if TRUE
6978
6979 Example :
6980 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
6981 userlist stats-auth
6982 group admin users admin
6983 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
6984 group readonly users haproxy
6985 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
6986
6987 backend stats_auth
6988 stats enable
6989 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
6990 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
6991 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
6992 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
6993
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006994 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
6995 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
6996 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006997
6998
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006999stats auth <user>:<passwd>
7000 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
7001 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007002 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007003 Arguments :
7004 <user> is a user name to grant access to
7005
7006 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
7007
7008 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
7009 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
7010 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
7011 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
7012 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
7013 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
7014
7015 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
7016 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
7017 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007018 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007019
7020 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
7021 report using "stats scope".
7022
7023 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7024 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7025 unobvious parameters.
7026
7027 Example :
7028 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7029 backend public_www
7030 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7031 stats enable
7032 stats hide-version
7033 stats scope .
7034 stats uri /admin?stats
7035 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7036 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7037 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7038
7039 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7040 backend private_monitoring
7041 stats enable
7042 stats uri /admin?stats
7043 stats refresh 5s
7044
7045 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
7046
7047
7048stats enable
7049 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
7050 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007051 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007052 Arguments : none
7053
7054 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
7055 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
7056 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
7057 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
7058 - stats auth : no authentication
7059 - stats scope : no restriction
7060
7061 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7062 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7063 unobvious parameters.
7064
7065 Example :
7066 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7067 backend public_www
7068 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7069 stats enable
7070 stats hide-version
7071 stats scope .
7072 stats uri /admin?stats
7073 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7074 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7075 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7076
7077 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7078 backend private_monitoring
7079 stats enable
7080 stats uri /admin?stats
7081 stats refresh 5s
7082
7083 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
7084
7085
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007086stats hide-version
7087 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007088 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007089 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007090 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007091
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007092 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
7093 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
7094 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
7095 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
7096 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
7097 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007098
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02007099 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7100 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7101 unobvious parameters.
7102
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007103 Example :
7104 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7105 backend public_www
7106 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02007107 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007108 stats hide-version
7109 stats scope .
7110 stats uri /admin?stats
7111 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7112 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7113 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007114
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007115 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7116 backend private_monitoring
7117 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007118 stats uri /admin?stats
7119 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01007120
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007121 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007122
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01007123
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02007124stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
7125 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7126 Access control for statistics
7127
7128 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7129 no | no | yes | yes
7130
7131 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
7132 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
7133 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
7134 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
7135 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
7136 should be asked to enter a username and password.
7137
7138 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
7139 instance.
7140
7141 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
7142 about ACL usage.
7143
7144
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007145stats realm <realm>
7146 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
7147 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007148 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007149 Arguments :
7150 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
7151 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
7152 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
7153
7154 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
7155 using a backslash ('\').
7156
7157 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
7158 only related to authentication.
7159
7160 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7161 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7162 unobvious parameters.
7163
7164 Example :
7165 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7166 backend public_www
7167 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7168 stats enable
7169 stats hide-version
7170 stats scope .
7171 stats uri /admin?stats
7172 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7173 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7174 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7175
7176 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7177 backend private_monitoring
7178 stats enable
7179 stats uri /admin?stats
7180 stats refresh 5s
7181
7182 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
7183
7184
7185stats refresh <delay>
7186 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
7187 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007188 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007189 Arguments :
7190 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
7191 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
7192 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
7193 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
7194 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
7195 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
7196
7197 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
7198 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
7199 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
7200 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
7201
7202 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7203 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7204 unobvious parameters.
7205
7206 Example :
7207 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7208 backend public_www
7209 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7210 stats enable
7211 stats hide-version
7212 stats scope .
7213 stats uri /admin?stats
7214 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7215 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7216 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7217
7218 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7219 backend private_monitoring
7220 stats enable
7221 stats uri /admin?stats
7222 stats refresh 5s
7223
7224 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
7225
7226
7227stats scope { <name> | "." }
7228 Enable statistics and limit access scope
7229 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007230 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007231 Arguments :
7232 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
7233 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
7234 section in which the statement appears.
7235
7236 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
7237 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
7238 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
7239 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
7240 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
7241 exists.
7242
7243 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7244 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7245 unobvious parameters.
7246
7247 Example :
7248 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7249 backend public_www
7250 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7251 stats enable
7252 stats hide-version
7253 stats scope .
7254 stats uri /admin?stats
7255 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7256 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7257 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7258
7259 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7260 backend private_monitoring
7261 stats enable
7262 stats uri /admin?stats
7263 stats refresh 5s
7264
7265 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
7266
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007267
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007268stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007269 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
7270 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007271 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007272
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007273 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007274 description from global section is automatically used instead.
7275
7276 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
7277 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
7278
7279 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7280 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007281 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007282
7283 Example :
7284 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7285 backend private_monitoring
7286 stats enable
7287 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
7288 stats uri /admin?stats
7289 stats refresh 5s
7290
7291 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
7292 global section.
7293
7294
7295stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007296 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
7297 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7298 yes | yes | yes | yes
7299 Arguments : none
7300
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007301 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007302 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
7303 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
7304 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
7305 - IP (socket, server)
7306 - cookie (backend, server)
7307
7308 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7309 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007310 unobvious parameters. Default behaviour is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007311
7312 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
7313
7314
7315stats show-node [ <name> ]
7316 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
7317 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007318 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007319 Arguments:
7320 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
7321 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
7322
7323 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
7324 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007325 provided for each customer. Default behaviour is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007326
7327 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7328 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7329 unobvious parameters.
7330
7331 Example:
7332 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7333 backend private_monitoring
7334 stats enable
7335 stats show-node Europe-1
7336 stats uri /admin?stats
7337 stats refresh 5s
7338
7339 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
7340 section.
7341
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007342
7343stats uri <prefix>
7344 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
7345 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007346 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007347 Arguments :
7348 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
7349 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
7350 query string.
7351
7352 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
7353 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
7354 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
7355 possible to reach it in the application.
7356
7357 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007358 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007359 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
7360 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
7361 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
7362 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
7363
7364 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
7365 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
7366 an address or a port to statistics only.
7367
7368 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7369 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7370 unobvious parameters.
7371
7372 Example :
7373 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7374 backend public_www
7375 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7376 stats enable
7377 stats hide-version
7378 stats scope .
7379 stats uri /admin?stats
7380 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7381 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7382 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7383
7384 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7385 backend private_monitoring
7386 stats enable
7387 stats uri /admin?stats
7388 stats refresh 5s
7389
7390 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
7391
7392
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007393stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
7394 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007395 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007396 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007397
7398 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007399 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007400 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
7401 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
7402 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
7403
7404 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
7405 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
7406 the "stick-table" statement.
7407
7408 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
7409 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
7410 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
7411 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
7412 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
7413
7414 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
7415 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
7416 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
7417 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
7418 transformation rules.
7419
7420 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
7421 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
7422 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
7423 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
7424 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
7425 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
7426 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
7427
7428 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
7429 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
7430 ACL based conditions.
7431
7432 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
7433 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
7434 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
7435 matches can be used as fallbacks.
7436
7437 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
7438 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
7439 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
7440 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
7441
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007442 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
7443 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
7444 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
7445
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007446 Example :
7447 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
7448 # last 30 minutes
7449 backend pop
7450 mode tcp
7451 balance roundrobin
7452 stick store-request src
7453 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
7454 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
7455 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
7456
7457 backend smtp
7458 mode tcp
7459 balance roundrobin
7460 stick match src table pop
7461 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
7462 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
7463
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007464 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007465 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007466
7467
7468stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
7469 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
7470 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7471 no | no | yes | yes
7472
7473 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
7474 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
7475 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
7476 for writing more maintainable configurations.
7477
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007478 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
7479 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
7480 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
7481
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007482 Examples :
7483 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01007484 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007485
7486 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
7487 stick match src table pop if !localhost
7488 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
7489
7490
7491 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
7492 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
7493 backend http
7494 mode http
7495 balance roundrobin
7496 stick on src table https
7497 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
7498 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
7499 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
7500
7501 backend https
7502 mode tcp
7503 balance roundrobin
7504 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
7505 stick on src
7506 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
7507 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
7508
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007509 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007510
7511
7512stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
7513 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
7514 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7515 no | no | yes | yes
7516
7517 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007518 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007519 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
7520 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
7521 server is selected.
7522
7523 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
7524 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
7525 the "stick-table" statement.
7526
7527 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
7528 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
7529 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
7530 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
7531 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
7532 address.
7533
7534 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
7535 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
7536 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
7537 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
7538 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
7539 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
7540 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
7541 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
7542 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
7543 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
7544
7545 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
7546 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
7547 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
7548 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
7549 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
7550 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
7551 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
7552
7553 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
7554 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
7555 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
7556 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
7557
7558 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
7559 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
7560 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
7561 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
7562 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
7563 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01007564 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
7565 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
7566 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
7567 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
7568 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
7569 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007570
7571 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
7572 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
7573 the request.
7574
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007575 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
7576 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
7577 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
7578
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007579 Example :
7580 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
7581 # last 30 minutes
7582 backend pop
7583 mode tcp
7584 balance roundrobin
7585 stick store-request src
7586 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
7587 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
7588 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
7589
7590 backend smtp
7591 mode tcp
7592 balance roundrobin
7593 stick match src table pop
7594 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
7595 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
7596
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007597 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007598 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007599
7600
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02007601stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02007602 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
7603 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08007604 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007605 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02007606 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007607
7608 Arguments :
7609 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
7610 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
7611 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
7612 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
7613
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01007614 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
7615 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
7616 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
7617 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
7618
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007619 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
7620 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
7621 instance.
7622
7623 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
7624 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
7625 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
7626 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
7627 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
7628 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02007629 to 32 characters.
7630
7631 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
7632 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
7633 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007634 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02007635 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
7636 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007637
7638 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02007639 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
7640 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007641 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
7642 increase.
7643
7644 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007645 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
7646 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
7647 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007648
7649 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
7650 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
7651 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
7652 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
7653 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
7654 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
7655 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
7656 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
7657 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
7658 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
7659 parameter (see below).
7660
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02007661 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
7662 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
7663 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
7664 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
7665 soft restart.
7666
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +02007667 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
7668 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007669
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007670 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
7671 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
7672 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
7673 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
7674 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007675 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007676 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
7677 if not expiration delay is specified.
7678
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02007679 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
7680 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
7681 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
7682 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007683 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
7684 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
7685 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
7686 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
7687 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
7688 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
7689 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
7690 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
7691 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
7692 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
7693 types and their arguments.
7694
7695 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
7696 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
7697 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
7698 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
7699
7700 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
7701 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
7702 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
7703 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
7704
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02007705 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
7706 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
7707 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
7708 a cumulative count, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
7709 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
7710 occurrence of certain events (eg: requests to a specific URL).
7711
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007712 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
7713 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
7714 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
7715 they were received.
7716
7717 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
7718 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
7719 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
7720 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
7721 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
7722
7723 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
7724 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7725 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7726 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
7727 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
7728
7729 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
7730 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
7731 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
7732
7733 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
7734 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7735 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7736 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
7737 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
7738
7739 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
7740 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
7741 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
7742 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
7743 the client side.
7744
7745 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
7746 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7747 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7748 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
7749 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
7750 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
7751 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
7752
7753 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
7754 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
7755 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
7756 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
7757 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
7758 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
7759 (eg: vulnerability scan).
7760
7761 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
7762 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7763 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7764 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
7765 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
7766 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
7767
7768 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
7769 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
7770 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
7771 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
7772
7773 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
7774 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7775 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7776 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
7777 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
7778 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
7779 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
7780 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
7781 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
7782 recommended for better fairness.
7783
7784 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
7785 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
7786 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
7787 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
7788
7789 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
7790 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7791 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7792 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
7793 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
7794 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
7795 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
7796 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
7797 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
7798 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02007799
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02007800 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
7801 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007802 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
7803 reference it.
7804
7805 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
7806 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
7807 lost upon restart. In general it can be good as a complement but not always
7808 as an exclusive stickiness.
7809
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007810 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
7811 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
7812 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
7813 something that can be ignored.
7814
7815 Example:
7816 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
7817 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
7818 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
7819 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
7820
7821 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01007822 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007823
7824
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007825stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
7826 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
7827 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7828 no | no | yes | yes
7829
7830 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007831 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007832 describes what elements of the response or connection will
7833 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
7834 server is selected.
7835
7836 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
7837 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
7838 the "stick-table" statement.
7839
7840 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
7841 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
7842 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
7843 when the response is a SSL server hello.
7844
7845 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
7846 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
7847 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
7848 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
7849 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
7850 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007851 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007852 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
7853 rules.
7854
7855 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
7856 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
7857 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
7858 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
7859 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
7860 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
7861 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
7862
7863 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
7864 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
7865 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
7866 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
7867
7868 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
7869 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
7870 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
7871 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
7872 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
7873 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01007874 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
7875 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
7876 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
7877 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
7878 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
7879 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
7880 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
7881 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
7882 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007883
7884 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
7885
7886 Example :
7887 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
7888 backend https
7889 mode tcp
7890 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007891 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007892 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007893
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007894 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
7895 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
7896
7897 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
7898 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
7899 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
7900
7901 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
7902 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007903
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007904 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
7905 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
7906 # at offset 44.
7907
7908 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
7909 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
7910
7911 # Learn on response if server hello.
7912 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007913
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007914 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
7915 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
7916
7917 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
7918 extraction.
7919
7920
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02007921tcp-check connect [params*]
7922 Opens a new connection
7923 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7924 no | no | yes | yes
7925
7926 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
7927 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
7928 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
7929
7930 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
7931 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
7932 of the sequence.
7933
7934 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
7935 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
7936 do.
7937
7938 Parameters :
7939 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
7940 use the TCP connection.
7941
7942 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
7943 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
7944 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
7945
7946 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
7947
7948 ssl opens a ciphered connection
7949
7950 Examples:
7951 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
7952 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
7953 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
7954 option tcp-check
7955 tcp-check connect
7956 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
7957 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
7958 tcp-check send \r\n
7959 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
7960 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
7961 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
7962 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
7963 tcp-check send \r\n
7964 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
7965 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
7966
7967 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
7968 option tcp-check
7969 tcp-check connect port 110
7970 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
7971 tcp-check connect port 143
7972 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
7973 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
7974
7975 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
7976
7977
7978tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
7979 Specify data to be collected and analysed during a generic health check
7980 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7981 no | no | yes | yes
7982
7983 Arguments :
7984 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
7985 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
7986 binary.
7987 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
7988 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
7989 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
7990
7991 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
7992 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
7993 with the usual backslash ('\').
7994 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
7995 a serie of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
7996 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
7997 used upper or lower case.
7998
7999
8000 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
8001
8002 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
8003 A health check response will be considered valid if the
8004 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
8005 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
8006 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
8007 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
8008 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
8009 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
8010
8011 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
8012 A health check response will be considered valid if the
8013 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
8014 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
8015 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
8016 expression.
8017
8018 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
8019 in the response buffer. A health check response will
8020 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
8021 this exact hexadecimal string.
8022 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
8023
8024 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
8025 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
8026 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
8027 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
8028 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
8029 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
8030 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
8031 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
8032 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
8033 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
8034 the null character.
8035
8036 Examples :
8037 # perform a POP check
8038 option tcp-check
8039 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
8040
8041 # perform an IMAP check
8042 option tcp-check
8043 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
8044
8045 # look for the redis master server
8046 option tcp-check
8047 tcp-check send PING\r\n
8048 tcp-check expect +PONG
8049 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
8050 tcp-check expect string role:master
8051 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
8052 tcp-check expect string +OK
8053
8054
8055 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
8056 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
8057
8058
8059tcp-check send <data>
8060 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
8061 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8062 no | no | yes | yes
8063
8064 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
8065 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
8066
8067 Examples :
8068 # look for the redis master server
8069 option tcp-check
8070 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
8071 tcp-check expect string role:master
8072
8073 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
8074 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
8075
8076
8077tcp-check send-binary <hexastring>
8078 Specify an hexa digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
8079 tcp health check
8080 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8081 no | no | yes | yes
8082
8083 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
8084 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
8085 <hexastring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
8086 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
8087 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
8088 hexadecimal string.
8089 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
8090
8091 Examples :
8092 # redis check in binary
8093 option tcp-check
8094 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
8095 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
8096
8097
8098 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
8099 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
8100
8101
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008102tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8103 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02008104 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8105 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008106 Arguments :
8107 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008108 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc0", "track-sc1",
8109 "track-sc2", and "expect-proxy". See below for more details.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02008110
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008111 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008112
8113 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
8114 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008115 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
8116 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
8117 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
8118 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
8119 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
8120 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008121
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008122 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
8123 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
8124 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
8125 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008126
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02008127 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008128 - accept :
8129 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
8130 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
8131 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008132
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008133 - reject :
8134 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
8135 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
8136 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
8137 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
8138 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
8139 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
8140 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
8141 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
8142 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
8143 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
8144 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
8145 be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008146
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02008147 - expect-proxy layer4 :
8148 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
8149 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
8150 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
8151 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
8152 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
8153 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
8154 hosts.
8155
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02008156 - capture <sample> len <length> :
8157 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
8158 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
8159 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
8160 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
8161 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
8162 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
8163 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
8164 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02008165 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
8166 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02008167
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008168 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008169 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02008170 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. 3 sets
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008171 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008172 first "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
8173 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008174 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008175 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
8176 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
8177 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
8178 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
8179 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008180
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008181 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008182 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008183 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008184 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
8185 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
8186 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
8187 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008188
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008189 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
8190 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
8191 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
8192 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008193
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008194 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
8195 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
8196 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
8197 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
8198 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008199 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
8200 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
8201 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
8202 layer7 information is extracted.
8203
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008204 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
8205 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
8206 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
8207 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
8208 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008209
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008210 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
8211 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
8212 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008213
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008214 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
8215 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
8216 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008217
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008218 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008219 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008220 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008221
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008222 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
8223 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
8224 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008225
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008226 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008227 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
8228 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008229
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02008230 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
8231
8232 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
8233
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008234 See section 7 about ACL usage.
8235
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008236 See also : "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008237
8238
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008239tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8240 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008241 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02008242 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008243 Arguments :
8244 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008245 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc0", "track-sc1",
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01008246 "track-sc2", "capture" and "lua". See "tcp-request connection"
8247 above for their signification.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008248
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008249 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008250
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008251 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
8252 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
8253 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
8254 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
8255 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008256
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008257 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
8258 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
8259 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
8260 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01008261 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
8262 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
8263 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
8264 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
8265 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
8266 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008267 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01008268 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008269
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008270 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
8271 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
8272 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
8273 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008274
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02008275 Four types of actions are supported :
8276 - accept : the request is accepted
8277 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
8278 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008279 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIER69717b42015-06-04 12:23:41 +02008280 - lua <function>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008281 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008282
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008283 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
8284 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008285
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01008286 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
8287 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
8288 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
8289 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
8290 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
8291 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008292
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008293 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008294 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
8295 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008296
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008297 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02008298 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
8299 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
8300 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
8301 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01008302 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
8303 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
8304 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008305
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008306 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02008307 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
8308 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
8309 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008310
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01008311 The "lua" keyword is followed by a Lua function name. It is used to run a Lua
8312 function if the action is executed. The single parameter is the name of the
8313 function to run. The prototype of the function is documented in the API
8314 documentation.
8315
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008316 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
8317 declared inline.
8318
8319 <var-name> The name of the variable starts by an indication about its scope.
8320 The allowed scopes are:
8321 "sess" : the variable is shared with all the session,
8322 "txn" : the variable is shared with all the transaction
8323 (request and response)
8324 "req" : the variable is shared only during the request
8325 processing
8326 "res" : the variable is shared only during the response
8327 processing.
8328 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
8329 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
8330
8331 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
8332 followed by some converters.
8333
8334 Example:
8335
8336 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
8337
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008338 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008339 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
8340 # and reject everything else.
8341 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
8342 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02008343 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008344 tcp-request content reject
8345
8346 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008347 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
8348 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
8349 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008350 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008351
8352 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
8353 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
8354 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008355 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008356 tcp-request content reject
8357
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008358 Example:
8359 # Track the last IP from X-Forwarded-For
8360 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02008361 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008362
8363 Example:
8364 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
8365 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02008366 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008367
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008368 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
8369 frontend when the backend detects abuse.
8370
8371 frontend http
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008372 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008373 # protecting all our sites
8374 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008375 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
8376 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008377 ...
8378 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
8379
8380 backend http_dynamic
8381 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008382 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008383 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008384 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
8385 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
8386 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008387 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008388
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008389 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008390
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008391 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request inspect-delay"
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008392
8393
8394tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
8395 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
8396 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02008397 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008398 Arguments :
8399 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8400 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8401 as explained at the top of this document.
8402
8403 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
8404 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
8405 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
8406 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
8407 data for at most the specified amount of time.
8408
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02008409 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
8410 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
8411 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
8412 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
8413
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008414 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
8415 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008416 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008417 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01008418 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
8419 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
8420 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
8421 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008422
8423 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
8424 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
8425 it pass through unaffected.
8426
8427 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
8428 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
8429 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008430 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008431 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
8432 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02008433 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
8434 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
8435 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008436
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008437 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008438 "timeout client".
8439
8440
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008441tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8442 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
8443 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8444 no | no | yes | yes
8445 Arguments :
8446 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01008447 actions include : "accept", "close", "reject", "lua".
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008448
8449 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
8450
8451 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
8452 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
8453 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02008454 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
8455 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008456
8457 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
8458
8459 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
8460 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
8461 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
8462 inserted.
8463
8464 Two types of actions are supported :
8465 - accept :
8466 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
8467 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
8468 the rules evaluation.
8469
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02008470 - close :
8471 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
8472 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
8473 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
8474 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
8475 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
8476 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008477 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02008478 protocols.
8479
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008480 - reject :
8481 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
8482 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008483 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008484
Thierry FOURNIER69717b42015-06-04 12:23:41 +02008485 - lua <function>
8486 Executes Lua.
8487
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008488 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
8489 Sets a variable.
8490
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008491 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
8492 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
8493 for changing the default action to a reject.
8494
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008495 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
8496 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
8497 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
8498 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008499 period.
8500
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01008501 The "lua" keyword is followed by a Lua function name. It is used to run a Lua
8502 function if the action is executed. The single parameter is the name of the
8503 function to run. The prototype of the function is documented in the API
8504 documentation.
8505
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008506 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
8507 declared inline.
8508
8509 <var-name> The name of the variable starts by an indication about its scope.
8510 The allowed scopes are:
8511 "sess" : the variable is shared with all the session,
8512 "txn" : the variable is shared with all the transaction
8513 (request and response)
8514 "req" : the variable is shared only during the request
8515 processing
8516 "res" : the variable is shared only during the response
8517 processing.
8518 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
8519 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
8520
8521 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
8522 followed by some converters.
8523
8524 Example:
8525
8526 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
8527
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008528 See section 7 about ACL usage.
8529
8530 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
8531
8532
8533tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
8534 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
8535 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8536 no | no | yes | yes
8537 Arguments :
8538 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8539 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8540 as explained at the top of this document.
8541
8542 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
8543
8544
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01008545timeout check <timeout>
8546 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
8547 established.
8548
8549 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8550 yes | no | yes | yes
8551 Arguments:
8552 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8553 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8554 as explained at the top of this document.
8555
8556 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
8557 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
8558 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
8559 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01008560 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
8561 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
8562 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01008563
8564 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
8565 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
8566
8567 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
8568 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01008569 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01008570
8571 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8572 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8573 forget about it.
8574
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01008575 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
8576 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01008577
8578
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008579timeout client <timeout>
8580timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
8581 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
8582 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8583 yes | yes | yes | no
8584 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008585 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008586 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8587 as explained at the top of this document.
8588
8589 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
8590 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
8591 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
8592 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
8593 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
8594 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
8595 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
8596 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008597 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008598 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008599 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
8600 sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008601 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
8602 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008603
8604 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
8605 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8606 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
8607 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
8608 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
8609 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
8610
8611 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
8612 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
8613 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
8614
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008615 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008616
8617
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008618timeout client-fin <timeout>
8619 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
8620 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8621 yes | yes | yes | no
8622 Arguments :
8623 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8624 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8625 as explained at the top of this document.
8626
8627 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
8628 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
8629 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
8630 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
8631 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
8632 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
8633 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
8634 down in one direction.
8635
8636 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
8637 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
8638 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
8639
8640 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
8641
8642
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008643timeout connect <timeout>
8644timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
8645 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
8646 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8647 yes | no | yes | yes
8648 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008649 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008650 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8651 as explained at the top of this document.
8652
8653 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008654 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008655 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008656 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01008657 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
8658 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008659
8660 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8661 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8662 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
8663 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
8664 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
8665 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
8666
8667 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
8668 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
8669 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
8670
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01008671 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
8672 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008673
8674
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01008675timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
8676 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
8677 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8678 yes | yes | yes | yes
8679 Arguments :
8680 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8681 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8682 as explained at the top of this document.
8683
8684 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
8685 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
8686 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
8687 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
8688 once the request has started to present itself.
8689
8690 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
8691 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
8692 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
8693 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
8694 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
8695
8696 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
8697 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
8698 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
8699 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
8700
8701 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
8702 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
8703 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
8704 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
8705 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02008706 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01008707
8708 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
8709 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
8710 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
8711 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
8712
8713 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
8714
8715
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008716timeout http-request <timeout>
8717 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
8718 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02008719 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008720 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008721 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008722 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8723 as explained at the top of this document.
8724
8725 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
8726 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
8727 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
8728 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
8729 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
8730 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
8731 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02008732 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
8733 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
8734 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
8735 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
8736 standard, well-documented behaviour, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008737 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
8738 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008739
8740 Note that this timeout only applies to the header part of the request, and
8741 not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is not
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01008742 used anymore. It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
8743 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008744
8745 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
8746 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
8747 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
8748 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
8749 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
8750
8751 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02008752 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
8753 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
8754 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008755
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008756 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
8757 "timeout client".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008758
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008759
8760timeout queue <timeout>
8761 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
8762 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8763 yes | no | yes | yes
8764 Arguments :
8765 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8766 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8767 as explained at the top of this document.
8768
8769 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
8770 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
8771 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
8772 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
8773 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
8774
8775 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
8776 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
8777 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
8778 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
8779
8780 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
8781
8782
8783timeout server <timeout>
8784timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
8785 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
8786 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8787 yes | no | yes | yes
8788 Arguments :
8789 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8790 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8791 as explained at the top of this document.
8792
8793 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
8794 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
8795 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
8796 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
8797 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
8798 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
8799 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
8800
8801 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
8802 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
8803 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
8804 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
8805 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008806 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008807 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008808 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
8809 with short-lived sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
8810 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
8811 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008812
8813 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8814 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8815 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
8816 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
8817 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
8818 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
8819
8820 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
8821 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
8822 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
8823
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008824 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008825
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008826
8827timeout server-fin <timeout>
8828 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
8829 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8830 yes | no | yes | yes
8831 Arguments :
8832 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8833 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8834 as explained at the top of this document.
8835
8836 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
8837 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
8838 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
8839 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
8840 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
8841 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
8842 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
8843 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
8844 situations, it should not be needed.
8845
8846 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8847 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
8848 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
8849
8850 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
8851
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008852
8853timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01008854 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008855 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8856 yes | yes | yes | yes
8857 Arguments :
8858 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
8859 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8860 as explained at the top of this document.
8861
8862 When a connection is tarpitted using "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with
8863 no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit"
8864 defines how long it will be maintained open.
8865
8866 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
8867 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
8868 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
8869 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01008870 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008871
8872 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
8873
8874
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008875timeout tunnel <timeout>
8876 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
8877 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8878 yes | no | yes | yes
8879 Arguments :
8880 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8881 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8882 as explained at the top of this document.
8883
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008884 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008885 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
8886 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
8887 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
8888 analyser remains attached to either connection (eg: tcp content rules are
8889 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (eg:
8890 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
8891 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
8892 specified.
8893
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008894 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
8895 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
8896 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
8897 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
8898 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
8899 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
8900 state.
8901
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008902 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
8903 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
8904 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
8905 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
8906 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
8907
8908 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8909 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8910 forget about it.
8911
8912 Example :
8913 defaults http
8914 option http-server-close
8915 timeout connect 5s
8916 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008917 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008918 timeout server 30s
8919 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
8920
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008921 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008922
8923
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008924transparent (deprecated)
8925 Enable client-side transparent proxying
8926 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01008927 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008928 Arguments : none
8929
8930 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
8931 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
8932 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
8933 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
8934 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
8935 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
8936 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
8937 appropriate server.
8938
8939 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
8940
8941 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
8942 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
8943
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008944 See also: "option transparent"
8945
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008946unique-id-format <string>
8947 Generate a unique ID for each request.
8948 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8949 yes | yes | yes | no
8950 Arguments :
8951 <string> is a log-format string.
8952
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008953 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
8954 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
8955 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
8956 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008957
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008958 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
8959 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
8960 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
8961 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
8962 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
8963 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
8964 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
8965 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008966
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008967 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
8968 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008969
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008970 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008971
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05008972 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008973
8974 will generate:
8975
8976 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
8977
8978 See also: "unique-id-header"
8979
8980unique-id-header <name>
8981 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
8982 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8983 yes | yes | yes | no
8984 Arguments :
8985 <name> is the name of the header.
8986
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008987 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
8988 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008989
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008990 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008991
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05008992 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008993 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
8994
8995 will generate:
8996
8997 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
8998
8999 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009000
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02009001use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02009002 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009003 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9004 no | yes | yes | no
9005 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01009006 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
9007 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009008
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02009009 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
9010 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009011
9012 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
9013 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
9014 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02009015 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
9016 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
9017 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
9018 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009019
9020 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
9021 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
9022 assign the backend.
9023
9024 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
9025 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
9026 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
9027 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
9028 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
9029 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
9030
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02009031 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009032 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02009033 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
9034 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
9035 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
9036
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01009037 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
9038 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
9039 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
9040 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
9041 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
9042 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
9043 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
9044 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
9045 cannot be forced from the request.
9046
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009047 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01009048 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
9049 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
9050
9051 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
9052 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009053
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009054
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02009055use-server <server> if <condition>
9056use-server <server> unless <condition>
9057 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
9058 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9059 no | no | yes | yes
9060 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009061 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02009062
9063 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
9064
9065 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
9066 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
9067 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
9068
9069 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
9070 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
9071 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
9072 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
9073 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
9074 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
9075 matches will assign the server.
9076
9077 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
9078 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
9079 with the next rules until one matches.
9080
9081 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
9082 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
9083 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
9084 according to other persistence mechanisms.
9085
9086 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
9087 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
9088 stripped.
9089
9090 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
9091 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
9092 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
9093 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
9094
9095 Example :
9096 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
9097 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
9098 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
9099 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
9100 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
9101 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
9102 server mail 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
9103 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
9104 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
9105
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009106 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02009107
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009108
91095. Bind and Server options
9110--------------------------
9111
9112The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
9113depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
9114settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
9115written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
9116described in this section.
9117
9118
91195.1. Bind options
9120-----------------
9121
9122The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
9123as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
9124no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
9125parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
9126while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
9127provided immediately after the setting name.
9128
9129The currently supported settings are the following ones.
9130
9131accept-proxy
9132 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +02009133 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
9134 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009135 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
9136 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
9137 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
9138 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
9139 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
9140 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
9141 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009142 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
9143 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009144
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02009145alpn <protocols>
9146 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
9147 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
9148 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
9149 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
9150 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
9151 initial NPN extension.
9152
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009153backlog <backlog>
9154 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
9155 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
9156
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02009157ecdhe <named curve>
9158 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +01009159 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
9160 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02009161
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02009162ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02009163 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9164 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
9165 client's certificate.
9166
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02009167ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
9168 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
9169 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
9170 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
9171 error is ignored.
9172
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02009173ca-sign-file <cafile>
9174 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9175 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
9176 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
9177 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
9178 'generate-certificates' for details.
9179
9180ca-sign-passphrase <passphrase>
9181 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
9182 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
9183 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
9184 'generate-certificates' for details.
9185
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009186ciphers <ciphers>
9187 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
9188 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009189 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake. The format of the string is defined
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009190 in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string
9191 such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes).
9192
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02009193crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02009194 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9195 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
9196 to verify client's certificate.
9197
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009198crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009199 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9200 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
9201 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
9202 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
9203 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
9204 file.
9205
9206 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
9207 are loaded.
9208
9209 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +01009210 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends with
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +01009211 '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This directive may be
9212 specified multiple times in order to load certificates from multiple files or
9213 directories. The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a
9214 valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN or alt
9215 subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used
9216 instead of the first hostname component (eg: *.example.org matches
9217 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009218
9219 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
9220 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
9221 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
9222 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +01009223 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
9224 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009225
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +02009226 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009227
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009228 Some CAs (such as Godaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
9229 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Godbach8bf60a12014-04-21 21:42:41 +08009230 choose a webserver that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009231 Godaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
9232 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
9233 clients).
9234
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +02009235 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
9236 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
9237 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
9238 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
9239 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
9240 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
9241 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
9242 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
9243 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
9244 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
9245 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
9246 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
9247 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
9248
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +01009249 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
9250 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
9251 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
9252 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
9253 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
9254
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02009255crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009256 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
9257 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009258 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009259 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02009260
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01009261crt-list <file>
9262 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02009263 designates a list of PEM file with an optional list of SNI filter per
9264 certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01009265
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02009266 <crtfile> [[!]<snifilter> ...]
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01009267
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02009268 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
9269 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
9270 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
9271 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
9272 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
9273 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
9274 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
9275 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01009276
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009277defer-accept
9278 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
9279 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
9280 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
9281 for which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly improve
9282 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
9283 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
9284 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
9285 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
9286 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
9287 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
9288 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
9289
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009290force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009291 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009292 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009293 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
9294 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*" and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009295
9296force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009297 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009298 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
9299 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*" and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009300
9301force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009302 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009303 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
9304 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*", and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009305
9306force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009307 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009308 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
9309 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*", and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009310
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02009311generate-certificates
9312 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9313 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
9314 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
9315 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
9316 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
9317 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
9318 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
9319 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
9320 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
9321 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
9322 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
9323
9324 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
9325 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
9326 increases the HAProxy's memroy footprint to reduce latency when the same
9327 certificate is used many times.
9328
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009329gid <gid>
9330 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
9331 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
9332 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
9333 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
9334 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
9335
9336group <group>
9337 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
9338 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
9339 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
9340 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
9341 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
9342
9343id <id>
9344 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
9345 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
9346 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
9347 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
9348
9349interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +01009350 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
9351 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
9352 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
9353 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
9354 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
9355 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
9356 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009357
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02009358level <level>
9359 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
9360 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
9361 sockets. <level> can be one of :
9362 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
9363 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
9364 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
9365 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
9366 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max
9367 counters).
9368 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
9369 all counters).
9370
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009371maxconn <maxconn>
9372 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
9373 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
9374 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
9375 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
9376 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
9377 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
9378 eat all memory.
9379
9380mode <mode>
9381 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
9382 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
9383 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
9384 UNIX sockets.
9385
9386mss <maxseg>
9387 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
9388 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
9389 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
9390 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
9391 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
9392 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
9393 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
9394 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
9395 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
9396 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
9397 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
9398
9399name <name>
9400 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
9401 page.
9402
9403nice <nice>
9404 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
9405 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
9406 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
9407 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
9408 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
9409 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
9410 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
9411 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
9412 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
9413 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
9414 one for an RDP socket.
9415
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009416no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009417 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009418 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009419 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009420 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
9421 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "force-tls*",
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009422 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009423
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +02009424no-tls-tickets
9425 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9426 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
9427 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009428 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
9429 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +02009430
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009431no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009432 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009433 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009434 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009435 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
9436 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
9437 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009438
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009439no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009440 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009441 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009442 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009443 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
9444 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
9445 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009446
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009447no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009448 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009449 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009450 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009451 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
9452 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
9453 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009454
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02009455npn <protocols>
9456 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
9457 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
9458 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
9459 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02009460 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
9461 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword).
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02009462
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02009463process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ]
9464 This restricts the list of processes on which this listener is allowed to
9465 run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do not match.
9466 If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection between the
9467 two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run on any
9468 remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either run on
9469 the first process of the listener if a single process was specified, or on
9470 all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. For the unlikely
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +02009471 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated. The
9472 main purpose of this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have
9473 one different socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind
9474 lines sharing the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so
9475 that the system can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues
9476 and allow a smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and
9477 above is known for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02009478
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009479ssl
9480 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009481 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009482 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
9483 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
9484 to deciphered contents.
9485
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +01009486strict-sni
9487 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
9488 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
9489 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
9490 See the "crt" option for more information.
9491
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +01009492tcp-ut <delay>
9493 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instanciated from this
9494 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
9495 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
9496 receiving an acknoledgement for the configured delay. This is especially
9497 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
9498 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
9499 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
9500 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
9501 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
9502 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
9503 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
9504
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02009505tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +01009506 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02009507 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
9508 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
9509 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
9510 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
9511 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
9512 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
9513 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +02009514 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
9515 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
9516 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02009517
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +01009518tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
9519 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
9520 bytes long, encoded with base64 (ex. openssl rand -base64 48). Number of keys
9521 is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO build option (default 3) and at least as
9522 many keys need to be present in the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be
9523 used for decryption and the penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy
9524 key rotation by just appending new key to the file and reloading the process.
9525 Keys must be periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy
9526 is compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
9527 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
9528 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
9529
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009530transparent
9531 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
9532 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
9533 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
9534 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
9535 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
9536 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
9537 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
9538 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
9539 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
9540 so check for support with your vendor.
9541
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01009542v4v6
9543 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
9544 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
9545 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
9546 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009547 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01009548
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01009549v6only
9550 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
9551 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
9552 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01009553 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
9554 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01009555
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009556uid <uid>
9557 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
9558 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
9559 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
9560 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
9561 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
9562
9563user <user>
9564 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
9565 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
9566 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
9567 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
9568 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
9569
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02009570verify [none|optional|required]
9571 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
9572 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
9573 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
9574 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
9575 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02009576 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
9577 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
9578 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
9579 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02009580
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020095815.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01009582------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009583
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01009584The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
9585which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
9586arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
9587settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
9588after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
9589Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
9590address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009591
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009592 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01009593 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009594
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009595The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009596
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02009597addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009598 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
9599 to send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate an IP
9600 address to specific component able to perform complex tests which are more
9601 suitable to health-checks than the application. This parameter is ignored if
9602 the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009603
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009604 Supported in default-server: No
9605
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009606agent-check
9607 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009608 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
9609 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string.
9610 The string is made of a series of words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas
9611 in any order, optionally terminated by '\r' and/or '\n', each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009612
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009613 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009614 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +02009615 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
9616 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
9617 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009618
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009619 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
9620 READY mode, thus cancelling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009621
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009622 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
9623 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
9624 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009625
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009626 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
9627 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
9628 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009629
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009630 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
9631 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
9632 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
9633 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
9634 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
9635 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (eg: missing process,
9636 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009637
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009638 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
9639 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009640
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009641 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
9642 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
9643 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
9644 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
9645 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
9646 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
9647 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
9648 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
9649 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009650
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +09009651 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
9652 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009653 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
9654 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
9655 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
9656 force an agent's result in order to workaround a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +09009657
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009658 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
9659 parameter.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009660
9661 Supported in default-server: No
9662
9663agent-inter <delay>
9664 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
9665 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
9666
9667 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
9668 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
9669 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
9670 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
9671 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
9672 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
9673 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
9674 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
9675 of backends use the same servers.
9676
9677 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
9678
9679 Supported in default-server: Yes
9680
9681agent-port <port>
9682 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
9683
9684 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
9685
9686 Supported in default-server: Yes
9687
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009688backup
9689 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
9690 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
9691 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
9692 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
9693 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "allbackups"
9694 option.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009695
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009696 Supported in default-server: No
9697
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02009698ca-file <cafile>
9699 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9700 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
9701 server's certificate.
9702
9703 Supported in default-server: No
9704
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009705check
9706 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +01009707 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
9708 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
9709 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
9710 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
9711 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
9712 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
9713 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09009714 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
9715 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
9716 refer to those options and parameters for more information.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009717
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009718 Supported in default-server: No
9719
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02009720check-send-proxy
9721 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
9722 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
9723 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
9724 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
9725 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
9726 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
9727 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
9728
9729 Supported in default-server: No
9730
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009731check-ssl
9732 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
9733 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
9734 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
9735 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009736 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009737 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
9738 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
9739 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (eg: ciphers).
9740 See the "ssl" option for more information.
9741
9742 Supported in default-server: No
9743
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009744ciphers <ciphers>
9745 This option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009746 is negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009747 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
9748 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
9749 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
9750 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
9751 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
9752 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
9753
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009754 Supported in default-server: No
9755
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009756cookie <value>
9757 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
9758 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
9759 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
9760 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
9761 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
9762 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
9763 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
9764
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009765 Supported in default-server: No
9766
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02009767crl-file <crlfile>
9768 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9769 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
9770 to verify server's certificate.
9771
9772 Supported in default-server: No
9773
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +02009774crt <cert>
9775 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
9776 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
9777 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
9778 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
9779 certificate request.
9780
9781 Supported in default-server: No
9782
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +02009783disabled
9784 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
9785 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
9786 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
9787 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
9788 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
9789
9790 Supported in default-server: No
9791
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009792error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01009793 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
9794 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
9795 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009796
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009797 Supported in default-server: Yes
9798
9799 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009800
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009801fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009802 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
9803 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
9804 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
9805
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009806 Supported in default-server: Yes
9807
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009808force-sslv3
9809 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
9810 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009811 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
9812 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009813
9814 Supported in default-server: No
9815
9816force-tlsv10
9817 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009818 the server. This option is also available on global statement
9819 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009820
9821 Supported in default-server: No
9822
9823force-tlsv11
9824 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009825 the server. This option is also available on global statement
9826 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009827
9828 Supported in default-server: No
9829
9830force-tlsv12
9831 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009832 the server. This option is also available on global statement
9833 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009834
9835 Supported in default-server: No
9836
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009837id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02009838 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
9839 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
9840 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009841
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009842 Supported in default-server: No
9843
9844inter <delay>
9845fastinter <delay>
9846downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009847 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
9848 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
9849 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
9850 between checks depending on the server state :
9851
9852 Server state | Interval used
9853 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
9854 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
9855 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
9856 Transitionally UP (going down), |
9857 Transitionally DOWN (going up), | "fastinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
9858 or yet unchecked. |
9859 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
9860 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
9861 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009862
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009863 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
9864 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
9865 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
9866 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009867 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
9868 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
9869 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
9870 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
9871 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009872
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009873 Supported in default-server: Yes
9874
9875maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009876 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
9877 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
9878 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
9879 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
9880 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
9881 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
9882 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
9883 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
9884
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009885 Supported in default-server: Yes
9886
9887maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009888 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
9889 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
9890 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
9891 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
9892 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
9893 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
9894 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
9895
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009896 Supported in default-server: Yes
9897
9898minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009899 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
9900 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
9901 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
9902 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
9903 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
9904 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009905 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009906 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009907
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009908 Supported in default-server: Yes
9909
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +01009910no-ssl-reuse
9911 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
9912 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
9913 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
9914 and for paranoid users.
9915
9916 Supported in default-server: No
9917
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009918no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009919 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
9920 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009921 using any configuration option. See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009922
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009923 Supported in default-server: No
9924
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +02009925no-tls-tickets
9926 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9927 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
9928 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009929 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
9930 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +02009931
9932 Supported in default-server: No
9933
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009934no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009935 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009936 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
9937 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009938 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
9939 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
9940 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009941
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009942 Supported in default-server: No
9943
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009944no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009945 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009946 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
9947 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009948 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
9949 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
9950 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009951
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009952 Supported in default-server: No
9953
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009954no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009955 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009956 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
9957 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009958 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
9959 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
9960 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009961
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009962 Supported in default-server: No
9963
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +09009964non-stick
9965 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
9966 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
9967 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
9968
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009969 Supported in default-server: No
9970
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009971observe <mode>
9972 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
9973 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
9974 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
9975 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
9976 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
9977 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +01009978 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009979
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009980 Supported in default-server: No
9981
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009982 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
9983
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009984on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009985 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
9986 Currently, four modes are available:
9987 - fastinter: force fastinter
9988 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
9989 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
9990 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
9991 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
9992
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009993 Supported in default-server: Yes
9994
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009995 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
9996
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09009997on-marked-down <action>
9998 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
9999 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070010000 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
10001 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
10002 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
10003 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
10004 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
10005 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
10006 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
10007 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090010008
10009 Actions are disabled by default
10010
10011 Supported in default-server: Yes
10012
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070010013on-marked-up <action>
10014 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
10015 Currently one action is available:
10016 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
10017 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
10018 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
10019 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
10020 with long sessions (eg: LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
10021 than it tries to solve (eg: incomplete transactions), so use this feature
10022 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
10023 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
10024
10025 Actions are disabled by default
10026
10027 Supported in default-server: Yes
10028
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010029port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010030 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
10031 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
10032 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
10033 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
10034 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
10035 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
10036
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010037 Supported in default-server: Yes
10038
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010039redir <prefix>
10040 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
10041 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
10042 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
10043 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
10044 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
10045 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
10046 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
10047 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010048 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010049 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
10050 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
10051 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
10052 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
10053 loop between the client and HAProxy!
10054
10055 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
10056
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010057 Supported in default-server: No
10058
10059rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010060 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
10061 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
10062 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
10063
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010064 Supported in default-server: Yes
10065
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020010066resolve-prefer <family>
10067 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
10068 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
10069 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
10070 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
10071
10072 Default value: ipv4
10073
10074 Example: server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
10075
10076resolvers <id>
10077 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
10078 hostname.
10079
10080 Example: server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns
10081
10082 See also chapter 5.3
10083
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010010084send-proxy
10085 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
10086 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
10087 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
10088 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
10089 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" listener,
10090 the advertised address will be used. Only TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families
10091 are supported. Other families such as Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN
10092 family. Servers using this option can fully be chained to another instance of
10093 haproxy listening with an "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020010094 used if the server isn't aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent
10095 to the server, the PROXY protocol is automatically used when this option is
10096 set, unless there is an explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an
10097 explicit "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY
10098 protocol. See also the "accept-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010010099
10100 Supported in default-server: No
10101
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040010102send-proxy-v2
10103 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
10104 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
10105 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
10106 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
10107 whatever the upper layer protocol. This setting must not be used if the
10108 server isn't aware of this version of the protocol. See also the "send-proxy"
10109 option of the "bind" keyword.
10110
10111 Supported in default-server: No
10112
10113send-proxy-v2-ssl
10114 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
10115 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
10116 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
10117 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
10118 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
10119 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
10120 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
10121 See also the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
10122
10123 Supported in default-server: No
10124
10125send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
10126 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
10127 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
10128 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
10129 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
10130 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
10131 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
10132 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
10133 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
10134 protocol. See also the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
10135
10136 Supported in default-server: No
10137
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010138slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010139 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
10140 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
10141 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
10142 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
10143 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
10144 parameters :
10145
10146 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
10147 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
10148
10149 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
10150 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
10151 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
10152 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
10153
10154 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
10155 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
10156 seen as failed.
10157
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010158 Supported in default-server: Yes
10159
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020010160source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010161source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020010162source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010163 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
10164 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
10165 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
10166 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
10167
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020010168 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
10169 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
10170 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
10171 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
10172 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
10173 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
10174 server.
10175
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010176 Supported in default-server: No
10177
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010178ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020010179 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
10180 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
10181 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
10182 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
10183 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
10184 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010185 See the "check-ssl" option to force SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010186
10187 Supported in default-server: No
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010188
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010189track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020010190 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
10191 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
10192 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
10193 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010194 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
10195
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010196 Supported in default-server: No
10197
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020010198verify [none|required]
10199 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010010200 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
10201 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file'
10202 and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. If 'ssl_server_verify' is not specified
10203 in global section, this is the default. On verify failure the handshake
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020010204 is aborted. It is critically important to verify server certificates when
10205 using SSL to connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to
10206 trivial man-in-the-middle attacks rendering SSL totally useless.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020010207
10208 Supported in default-server: No
10209
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070010210verifyhost <hostname>
10211 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
10212 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. When set, the
10213 hostnames in the subject and subjectAlternateNames of the certificate
10214 provided by the server are checked. If none of the hostnames in the
10215 certificate match the specified hostname, the handshake is aborted. The
10216 hostnames in the server-provided certificate may include wildcards.
10217
10218 Supported in default-server: No
10219
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010220weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010221 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
10222 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
10223 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020010224 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
10225 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
10226 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
10227 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
10228 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
10229 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010230
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010231 Supported in default-server: Yes
10232
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010233
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200102345.3 Server IP address resolution using DNS
10235------------------------------------------
10236
10237HAProxy allows using a host name to be resolved to find out what is the server
10238IP address. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
10239configuration, at startup.
10240This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
10241can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
10242workload.
10243This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
10244resolution at run time.
10245Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
10246carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
10247
10248
102495.3.1 Global overview
10250---------------------
10251
10252As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
10253different steps of the process life:
10254
10255 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
10256 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
10257 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
10258
10259 2. at run time, when HAProxy gets prepared to run a health check on a server,
10260 it verifies if the current name resolution is still considered as valid.
10261 If not, it processes a new resolution, in parallel of the health check.
10262
10263A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
10264 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
10265 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
10266 resolution to know this new IP.
10267
10268A few things important to notice:
10269 - all the name servers are queried in the mean time. HAProxy will process the
10270 first valid response.
10271
10272 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
10273 servers return an error.
10274
10275
102765.3.2 The resolvers section
10277---------------------------
10278
10279This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
10280HAProxy.
10281There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can contain
10282many name servers.
10283
10284resolvers <resolvers id>
10285 Creates a new name server list labelled <resolvers id>
10286
10287A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
10288
10289nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
10290 DNS server description:
10291 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
10292 <ip> : IP address of the server
10293 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
10294
10295hold <status> <period>
10296 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
10297 on last resolution <status>
10298 <status> : last name resolution status. Only "valid" is accepted for now.
10299 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
10300 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
10301 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
10302
10303 Default value is 10s for "valid".
10304
10305 Note: since the name resolution is triggered by the health checks, a new
10306 resolution is triggered after <period> modulo the <inter> parameter of
10307 the healch check.
10308
10309resolve_retries <nb>
10310 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
10311 giving up.
10312 Default value: 3
10313
10314timeout <event> <time>
10315 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
10316 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
10317 events available are:
10318 - retry: time between two DNS queries, when no response have
10319 been received.
10320 Default value: 1s
10321 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
10322 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
10323
10324Example of a resolvers section (with default values):
10325
10326 resolvers mydns
10327 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
10328 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
10329 resolve_retries 3
10330 timeout retry 1s
10331 hold valid 10s
10332
10333
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200103346. HTTP header manipulation
10335---------------------------
10336
10337In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
10338response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
10339request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
10340which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010010341against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010342
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010010343If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
10344to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
10345but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
10346HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
10347stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
10348because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
10349a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
10350still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +020010351
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010352This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
10353in section 4.2 :
10354
10355 - reqadd <string>
10356 - reqallow <search>
10357 - reqiallow <search>
10358 - reqdel <search>
10359 - reqidel <search>
10360 - reqdeny <search>
10361 - reqideny <search>
10362 - reqpass <search>
10363 - reqipass <search>
10364 - reqrep <search> <replace>
10365 - reqirep <search> <replace>
10366 - reqtarpit <search>
10367 - reqitarpit <search>
10368 - rspadd <string>
10369 - rspdel <search>
10370 - rspidel <search>
10371 - rspdeny <search>
10372 - rspideny <search>
10373 - rsprep <search> <replace>
10374 - rspirep <search> <replace>
10375
10376With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
10377is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
10378parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
10379prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
10380Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
10381
10382 \t for a tab
10383 \r for a carriage return (CR)
10384 \n for a new line (LF)
10385 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
10386 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
10387 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
10388 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
10389 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
10390
10391The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
10392portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
10393above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
10394regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
103959 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
10396is very common to users of the "sed" program.
10397
10398The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
10399after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
10400
10401Notes related to these keywords :
10402---------------------------------
10403 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
10404 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
10405 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
10406
10407 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
10408 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
10409 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
10410
10411 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
10412 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
10413 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
10414 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
10415 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
10416
10417 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
10418 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
10419 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
10420 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
10421 useless headers before adding new ones.
10422
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010423 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010424 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
10425
10426 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
10427 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
10428 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
10429
10430 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
10431 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010432 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010433
10434
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200104357. Using ACLs and fetching samples
10436----------------------------------
10437
10438Haproxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
10439client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
10440The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
10441these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
10442but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
10443data called patterns.
10444
10445
104467.1. ACL basics
10447---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010448
10449The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
10450content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
10451from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
10452simple :
10453
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010454 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010010455 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010456 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
10457 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010458
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010459The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
10460adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010461
10462In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
10463
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010464 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010465
10466This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
10467Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
10468and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010010469an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
10470conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
10471as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
10472are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010473
10474ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
10475'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
10476which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
10477
10478There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
10479performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
10480
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010481The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
10482specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
10483this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010010484methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
10485ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010486
10487Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
10488 - boolean
10489 - integer (signed or unsigned)
10490 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
10491 - string
10492 - data block
10493
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010010494Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
10495converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
10496would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
10497The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
10498which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
10499
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020010500Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
10501keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
10502fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
10503which are summarized in the table below :
10504
10505 +---------------------+-----------------+
10506 | Sample or converter | Default |
10507 | output type | matching method |
10508 +---------------------+-----------------+
10509 | boolean | bool |
10510 +---------------------+-----------------+
10511 | integer | int |
10512 +---------------------+-----------------+
10513 | ip | ip |
10514 +---------------------+-----------------+
10515 | string | str |
10516 +---------------------+-----------------+
10517 | binary | none, use "-m" |
10518 +---------------------+-----------------+
10519
10520Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
10521matching method, see below.
10522
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010523The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
10524 - boolean
10525 - integer or integer range
10526 - IP address / network
10527 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
10528 - regular expression
10529 - hex block
10530
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010531The following ACL flags are currently supported :
10532
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020010533 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
10534 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010535 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010010536 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010010537 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010010538 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010539 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
10540
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010541The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
10542read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
10543if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
10544lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
10545will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
10546beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
10547a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
10548lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
10549exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
10550
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010010551The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
10552parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
10553ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
10554a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
10555check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
10556
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010010557The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
10558socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
10559file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
10560
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010561Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
10562loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
10563
10564 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
10565
10566In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
10567the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
10568case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
10569as well.
10570
10571The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
10572sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
10573do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
10574methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
10575is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
10576obvious matching method (eg: string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
10577followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
10578default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
10579that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
10580string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
10581
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010010582The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
10583By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
10584string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
10585resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
10586server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
10587waiting fir the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
10588flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
10589function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
10590
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010591There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
10592sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
10593be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010594
10595 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
10596 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010597 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
10598 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
10599 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
10600 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010601
10602 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
10603 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010604 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010605
10606 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010607 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010608
10609 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010610 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010611
10612 - "bin" : match the contents against an hexadecimal string representing a
10613 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
10614
10615 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
10616 binary or string samples.
10617
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010618 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
10619 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010620
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010621 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
10622 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
10623 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010624
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010625 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
10626 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010627
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010628 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
10629 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010630
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010631 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
10632 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010633
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010634 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
10635 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010636 This may be used with binary or string samples.
10637
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010638 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
10639 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
10640 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010641
10642For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
10643request, it is possible to do :
10644
10645 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
10646
10647In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
10648buffer, one would use the following acl :
10649
10650 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
10651
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010010652On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
10653possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
10654
10655 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
10656
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010657All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
10658criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
10659method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
10660to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
10661criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
10662the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020010663
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010664If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010665the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
10666For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020010667
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010668 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
10669 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
10670 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
10671 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020010672
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020010673
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020010674The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
10675types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
10676combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
10677brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
10678default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010679
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010680 +-------------------------------------------------+
10681 | Input sample type |
10682 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020010683 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010684 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
10685 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
10686 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020010687 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010688 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020010689 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010690 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010010691 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010692 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020010693 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010694 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020010695 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010696 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010010697 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010698 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010010699 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010700 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010010701 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010702 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010010703 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010704 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010010705 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010706 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010010707 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010708 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
10709 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
10710 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010711
10712
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200107137.1.1. Matching booleans
10714------------------------
10715
10716In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
10717Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
10718When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
10719that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
10720
10721Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
10722return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
10723"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
10724
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010725
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200107267.1.2. Matching integers
10727------------------------
10728
10729Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
10730enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
10731to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
10732
10733Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
10734matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
10735lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010736
10737For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
10738unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
10739representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
10740
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010741As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
10742two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
10743instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
10744ranges and operators.
10745
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010746For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010747operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
10748Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
10749of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010750
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010751Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010752
10753 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
10754 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
10755 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
10756 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
10757 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
10758
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010759For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010760
10761 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
10762
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010763This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
10764
10765 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
10766
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010767
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200107687.1.3. Matching strings
10769-----------------------
10770
10771String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
10772different forms :
10773
10774 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
10775 patterns ;
10776
10777 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
10778 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside ;
10779
10780 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
10781 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
10782
10783 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
10784 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
10785
10786 - subdir match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
10787 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
10788 matches.
10789
10790 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
10791 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
10792 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010793
10794String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
10795exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
10796characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
10797string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
10798to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010799before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010800
10801
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200108027.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
10803---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010804
10805Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
10806they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
10807possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
10808passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
10809the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010810the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
10811match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010812
10813
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200108147.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
10815-------------------------------------
10816
10817It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
10818not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
10819a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
10820to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
10821digits may be used upper or lower case.
10822
10823Example :
10824 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
10825 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
10826
10827
108287.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
10829---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010830
10831IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
10832netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
10833within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010834host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010835difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
10836at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
10837does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
10838parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010839
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020010840IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
10841Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
10842trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
10843IPv6 patterns.
10844
10845HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
10846following situations :
10847 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
10848 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
10849 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
10850 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
10851 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
10852 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
10853 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
10854 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
10855 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
10856 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
10857
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010858
108597.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
10860----------------------------------
10861
10862Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
10863combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
10864
10865 - AND (implicit)
10866 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
10867 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010868
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010869A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010870
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010871 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020010872
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010873Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
10874indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020010875
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010876For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
10877"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
10878requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
10879is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
10880
10881 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
10882 block if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
10883 block if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
10884 block unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
10885
10886To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
10887and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
10888
10889 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
10890 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
10891 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
10892 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
10893
10894 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
10895 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
10896 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
10897 use_backend www if host_www
10898
10899It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
10900expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
10901be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
10902the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
10903
10904 The following rule :
10905
10906 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
10907 block if METH_POST missing_cl
10908
10909 Can also be written that way :
10910
10911 block if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
10912
10913It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
10914to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
10915simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
10916sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
10917good use is the following :
10918
10919 With named ACLs :
10920
10921 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
10922 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
10923 monitor fail if site_dead
10924
10925 With anonymous ACLs :
10926
10927 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
10928
10929See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "block" and "use_backend" keywords.
10930
10931
109327.3. Fetching samples
10933---------------------
10934
10935Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
10936against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
10937sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
10938ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
10939of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
10940available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
10941
10942This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
10943Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
10944compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
10945deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
10946
10947The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
10948matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
10949method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
10950indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
10951
10952As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
10953when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
10954mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
10955the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
10956ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
10957
10958Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
10959multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
10960when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
10961incorrect argument (eg: an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
10962are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
10963is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
10964all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
10965
10966Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
10967 - name
10968 - name(arg1)
10969 - name(arg1,arg2)
10970
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010971
109727.3.1. Converters
10973-----------------
10974
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010010975Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
10976of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
10977is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
10978was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
10979has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (acls, log-format,
10980unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
10981
10982These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
10983sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
10984the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
10985support some arguments (eg: a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010986
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010010987A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
10988support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
10989supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
10990(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
10991bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
10992
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010993The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010994
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010010995add(<value>)
10996 Adds <value> to the input value of type unsigned integer, and returns the
10997 result as an unsigned integer.
10998
10999and(<value>)
11000 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type unsigned
11001 integer, and returns the result as an unsigned integer.
11002
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020011003base64
11004 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
11005 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg:
11006 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
11007
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011008bool
11009 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type unsigned integer is
11010 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
11011 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (eg: verify the
11012 presence of a flag).
11013
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010011014bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
11015 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
11016 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
11017 optionnaly truncated at the given length.
11018
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011019cpl
11020 Takes the input value of type unsigned integer, applies a twos-complement
11021 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an unsigned integer.
11022
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010011023crc32([<avalanche>])
11024 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
11025 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
11026 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
11027 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
11028 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
11029 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
11030 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
11031 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
11032 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
11033 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
11034 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6" and the "hash-type" directive.
11035
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020011036da-csv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
11037 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
11038 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
11039 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
11040 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
11041 ('|'). There's a limit of 5 different properties imposed by the haproxy
11042 configuration language.
11043
11044 Example:
11045 frontend www
11046 bind *:8881
11047 default_backend servers
11048 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion)]
11049
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020011050debug
11051 This converter is used as debug tool. It dumps on screen the content and the
11052 type of the input sample. The sample is returned as is on its output. This
11053 converter only exists when haproxy was built with debugging enabled.
11054
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011055div(<value>)
11056 Divides the input value of type unsigned integer by <value>, and returns the
11057 result as an unsigned integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
11058 integer is returned (typically 2^32-1).
11059
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020011060djb2([<avalanche>])
11061 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
11062 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
11063 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
11064 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
11065 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
11066 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
11067 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010011068 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6" and the
11069 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020011070
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011071even
11072 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type unsigned integer is even
11073 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
11074
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010011075field(<index>,<delimiters>)
11076 Extracts the substring at the given index considering given delimiters from
11077 an input string. Indexes start at 1 and delimiters are a string formatted
11078 list of chars.
11079
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011080hex
11081 Converts a binary input sample to an hex string containing two hex digits per
11082 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
11083 in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg: an SSL ID can be copied in a
11084 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010011085
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011086http_date([<offset>])
11087 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
11088 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
11089 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
11090 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
11091 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
11092 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011093
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020011094in_table(<table>)
11095 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11096 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
11097 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
11098 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (eg: whether
11099 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
11100
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020011101ipmask(<mask>)
11102 Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
11103 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
11104 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask can be passed in
11105 dotted form (eg: 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
11106
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020011107json([<input-code>])
11108 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII ouput string ready to use as a
11109 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
11110 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8"" or
11111 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
11112 of errors:
11113 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
11114 bytes, ...)
11115 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
11116 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
11117
11118 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
11119 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
11120 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
11121 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
11122 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
11123 are :
11124 - "ascii" : never fails ;
11125 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors ;
11126 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors ;
11127 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
11128 error ;
11129 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
11130 characters corresponding to the other errors.
11131
11132 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
11133 logging to servers which consume JSON-formated traffic logs.
11134
11135 Example:
11136 capture request header user-agent len 150
11137 capture request header Host len 15
11138 log-format {"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json]"}
11139
11140 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
11141 GET / HTTP/1.0
11142 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
11143
11144 Output log:
11145 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
11146
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011147language(<value>[,<default>])
11148 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
11149 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
11150 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
11151 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
11152 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
11153 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
11154 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
11155 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
11156 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
11157 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
11158 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
11159 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020011160
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011161 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020011162
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011163 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
11164 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020011165
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011166 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
11167 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
11168 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
11169 use_backend spanish if es
11170 use_backend french if fr
11171 use_backend english if en
11172 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020011173
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020011174lower
11175 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
11176 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
11177 type. The result is of type string.
11178
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020011179ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
11180 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
11181 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
11182 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
11183 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
11184 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
11185 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
11186
11187 Example :
11188
11189 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
11190 # Eg: 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
11191 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
11192
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011193map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
11194map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
11195map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
11196 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
11197 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
11198 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
11199 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
11200 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
11201 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
11202 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
11203 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010011204
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011205 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
11206 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
11207 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010011208
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011209 The following array contains the list of all map functions avalaible sorted by
11210 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010011211
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011212 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
11213 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
11214 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
11215 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020011216 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
11217 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011218 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
11219 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
11220 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
11221 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
11222 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
11223 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
11224 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
11225 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
11226 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
11227 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
11228 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
11229 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
11230 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
11231 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010011232
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011233 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
11234 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
11235 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
11236 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
11237 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010011238
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011239 Example :
11240
11241 # this is a comment and is ignored
11242 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
11243 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
11244 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
11245 | | | `---------- value
11246 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
11247 | `---------------------------- key
11248 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
11249
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011250mod(<value>)
11251 Divides the input value of type unsigned integer by <value>, and returns the
11252 remainder as an unsigned integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
11253
11254mul(<value>)
11255 Multiplies the input value of type unsigned integer by <value>, and returns
11256 the product as an unsigned integer. In case of overflow, the higher bits are
11257 lost, leading to seemingly strange values.
11258
11259neg
11260 Takes the input value of type unsigned integer, computes the opposite value,
11261 and returns the remainder as an unsigned integer. 0 is identity. This
11262 operator is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input
11263 from a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
11264
11265not
11266 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type unsigned integer is
11267 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
11268 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (eg: verify the
11269 absence of a flag).
11270
11271odd
11272 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type unsigned integer is odd
11273 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
11274
11275or(<value>)
11276 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type unsigned
11277 integer, and returns the result as an unsigned integer.
11278
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010011279regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010011280 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
11281 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
11282 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
11283 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
11284 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
11285 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
11286 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
11287 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
11288 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
11289 It is important to note that due to the current limitations of the
11290 configuration parser, some characters such as closing parenthesis or comma
11291 are not possible to use in the arguments. The first use of this converter is
11292 to replace certain characters or sequence of characters with other ones.
11293
11294 Example :
11295
11296 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
11297 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
11298 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
11299 http-request set-header x-path %[hdr(x-path),regsub(/+,/,g)]
11300
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020011301capture-req(<id>)
11302 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
11303 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
11304
11305 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
11306 "http-response capture", "req.hdr.capture" and
11307 "res.hdr.capture" (sample fetches).
11308
11309capture-res(<id>)
11310 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
11311 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
11312
11313 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
11314 "http-response capture", "req.hdr.capture" and
11315 "res.hdr.capture" (sample fetches).
11316
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020011317sdbm([<avalanche>])
11318 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
11319 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
11320 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
11321 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
11322 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
11323 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
11324 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010011325 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6" and the
11326 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020011327
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011328set-var(<var name>)
11329 Sets a variable with the input content and return the content on the output as
11330 is. The variable keep the value and the associated input type. The name of the
11331 variable starts by an indication about it scope. The scope allowed are:
11332 "sess" : the variable is shared with all the session,
11333 "txn" : the variable is shared with all the transaction (request and
11334 response),
11335 "req" : the variable is shared only during the request processing,
11336 "res" : the variable is shared only during the response processing.
11337 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
11338 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
11339
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011340sub(<value>)
11341 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type unsigned integer, and returns
11342 the result as an unsigned integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
11343 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
11344
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020011345table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
11346 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11347 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11348 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
11349 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
11350 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
11351 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
11352
11353
11354table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
11355 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11356 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11357 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
11358 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
11359 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
11360 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
11361
11362table_conn_cnt(<table>)
11363 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11364 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11365 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of incoming
11366 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
11367 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
11368
11369table_conn_cur(<table>)
11370 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11371 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11372 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
11373 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
11374 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
11375
11376table_conn_rate(<table>)
11377 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11378 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11379 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
11380 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
11381 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
11382
11383table_gpc0(<table>)
11384 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11385 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11386 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
11387 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
11388 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
11389
11390table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
11391 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11392 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11393 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
11394 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
11395 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
11396 sample fetch keyword.
11397
11398table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
11399 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11400 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11401 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of HTTP
11402 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
11403 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
11404
11405table_http_err_rate(<table>)
11406 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11407 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11408 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
11409 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
11410 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
11411 keyword.
11412
11413table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
11414 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11415 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11416 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of HTTP
11417 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
11418 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
11419
11420table_http_req_rate(<table>)
11421 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11422 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11423 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
11424 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
11425 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
11426 keyword.
11427
11428table_kbytes_in(<table>)
11429 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11430 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11431 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of client-
11432 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
11433 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
11434 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
11435 keyword.
11436
11437table_kbytes_out(<table>)
11438 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11439 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11440 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of server-
11441 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
11442 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
11443 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
11444 keyword.
11445
11446table_server_id(<table>)
11447 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11448 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11449 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
11450 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
11451 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
11452 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
11453
11454table_sess_cnt(<table>)
11455 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11456 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11457 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of incoming
11458 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
11459 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
11460 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
11461 keyword.
11462
11463table_sess_rate(<table>)
11464 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11465 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11466 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
11467 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
11468 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
11469 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
11470 keyword.
11471
11472table_trackers(<table>)
11473 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11474 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11475 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
11476 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
11477 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
11478 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
11479 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
11480 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
11481 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
11482 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
11483
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020011484upper
11485 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
11486 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
11487 type. The result is of type string.
11488
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020011489url_dec
11490 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded
11491 version as output. The input and the output are of type string.
11492
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020011493utime(<format>[,<offset>])
11494 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
11495 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
11496 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
11497 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
11498 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
11499 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
11500
11501 Example :
11502
11503 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
11504 # Eg: 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
11505 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
11506
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010011507word(<index>,<delimiters>)
11508 Extracts the nth word considering given delimiters from an input string.
11509 Indexes start at 1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
11510
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020011511wt6([<avalanche>])
11512 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
11513 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
11514 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
11515 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
11516 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
11517 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
11518 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010011519 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", and the
11520 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020011521
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011522xor(<value>)
11523 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
11524 of type unsigned integer, and returns the result as an unsigned integer.
11525
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010011526
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200115277.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011528--------------------------------------------
11529
11530A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
11531not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
11532"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
11533The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
11534
11535always_false : boolean
11536 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
11537 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
11538
11539always_true : boolean
11540 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
11541 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
11542
11543avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011544 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011545 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
11546 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
11547 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
11548 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
11549 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
11550 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
11551 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
11552 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
11553 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
11554 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
11555 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
11556 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
11557 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010011558
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011559be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020011560 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
11561 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
11562 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
11563 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
11564 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011565
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011566be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
11567 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
11568 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
11569 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
11570 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent sucking of an
11571 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
11572 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011573
11574 Example :
11575 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
11576 backend dynamic
11577 mode http
11578 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
11579 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011580
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011581connslots([<backend>]) : integer
11582 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011583 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011584 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
11585 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050011586
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080011587 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011588 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080011589 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
11590
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011591 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
11592 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080011593
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020011594 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011595 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011596 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011597 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
11598 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011599 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020011600 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080011601
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011602 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
11603 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011604 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011605 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080011606
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020011607date([<offset>]) : integer
11608 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
11609 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
11610 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
11611 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020011612 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
11613
11614 Example :
11615
11616 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
11617 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020011618
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020011619env(<name>) : string
11620 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
11621 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
11622 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
11623 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
11624 certain way.
11625
11626 Examples :
11627 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
11628 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
11629
11630 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
11631 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
11632
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011633fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
11634 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011635 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
11636 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011637 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
11638 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
11639 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
11640 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
11641 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020011642
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011643fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
11644 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
11645 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
11646 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
11647 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
11648 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
11649 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
11650 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
11651 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010011652
11653 Example :
11654 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
11655 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
11656 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
11657 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
11658 frontend mail
11659 bind :25
11660 mode tcp
11661 maxconn 100
11662 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
11663 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
11664 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
11665 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011666
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010011667nbproc : integer
11668 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
11669 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
11670 and debugging purposes.
11671
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011672nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
11673 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
11674 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
11675 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011676 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
11677 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
11678 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010011679
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010011680proc : integer
11681 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
11682 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
11683 debugging purposes.
11684
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011685queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011686 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
11687 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
11688 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011689 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
11690 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
11691 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
11692 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
11693 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
11694
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010011695rand([<range>]) : integer
11696 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
11697 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
11698 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
11699 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
11700 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
11701
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011702srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
11703 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
11704 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
11705 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
11706 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
11707 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
11708 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" fetch
11709 methods.
11710
11711srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
11712 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
11713 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
11714 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
11715 an external status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's
11716 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
11717 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
11718 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
11719
11720srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
11721 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
11722 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011723 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011724 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
11725 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
11726 rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent latent requests from
11727 overloading servers).
11728
11729 Example :
11730 # Redirect to a separate back
11731 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
11732 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
11733 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
11734
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010011735stopping : boolean
11736 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
11737 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
11738 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
11739
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011740table_avl([<table>]) : integer
11741 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
11742 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
11743
11744table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11745 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
11746 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
11747 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
11748
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011749var(<var-name>) : undefined
11750 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
11751 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts by an indication about its
11752 scope. The scope allowed are:
11753 "sess" : the variable is shared with all the session,
11754 "txn" : the variable is shared with all the transaction (request and
11755 response),
11756 "req" : the variable is shared only during the request processing,
11757 "res" : the variable is shared only during the response processing.
11758 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
11759 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
11760
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011761
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200117627.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011763----------------------------------
11764
11765The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
11766closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
11767methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
11768sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
11769TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011770the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
11771counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
11772"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix, or it can be specified as the first integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011773argument when using the "sc_" prefix. An optional table may be specified with
11774the "sc*" form, in which case the currently tracked key will be looked up into
11775this alternate table instead of the table currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011776
11777be_id : integer
11778 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
11779 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
11780
11781dst : ip
11782 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
11783 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
11784 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
11785 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
11786 RFC 4291.
11787
11788dst_conn : integer
11789 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
11790 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
11791 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
11792 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
11793 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
11794 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
11795 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
11796 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011797
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011798dst_port : integer
11799 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
11800 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
11801 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
11802 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
11803 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
11804 an HTTP header.
11805
11806fe_id : integer
11807 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
11808 backends to check from which backend it was called, or to stick all users
11809 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
11810
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011811sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011812sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
11813sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
11814sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011815 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
11816 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
11817 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
11818
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011819sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011820sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
11821sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
11822sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011823 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
11824 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
11825 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
11826
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011827sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011828sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
11829sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
11830sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020011831 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
11832 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010011833 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
11834 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
11835 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020011836
11837 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
11838 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011839 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
11840 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
11841 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020011842 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
11843 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
11844
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011845sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011846sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11847sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11848sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011849 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
11850 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
11851
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011852sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011853sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
11854sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
11855sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011856 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
11857 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
11858 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
11859
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011860sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011861sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
11862sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
11863sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011864 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
11865 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
11866 See also src_conn_rate.
11867
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011868sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011869sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
11870sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
11871sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011872 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011873 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011874
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011875sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011876sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
11877sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
11878sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011879 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
11880 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
11881 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011882 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
11883 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
11884 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011885
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011886sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011887sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11888sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11889sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011890 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
11891 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
11892 See also src_http_err_cnt.
11893
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011894sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011895sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
11896sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
11897sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011898 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
11899 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
11900 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
11901 src_http_err_rate.
11902
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011903sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011904sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11905sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11906sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011907 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
11908 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
11909 src_http_req_cnt.
11910
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011911sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011912sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
11913sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
11914sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011915 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
11916 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
11917 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
11918 src_http_req_rate.
11919
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011920sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011921sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
11922sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
11923sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011924 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010011925 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
11926 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
11927 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
11928 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011929
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011930 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
11931 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011932 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
11933
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011934sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011935sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
11936sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
11937sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020011938 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
11939 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
11940 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011941
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011942sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011943sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
11944sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
11945sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020011946 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
11947 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
11948 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011949
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011950sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011951sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11952sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11953sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011954 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
11955 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
11956 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
11957 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011958 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011959 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
11960
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011961sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011962sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
11963sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
11964sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011965 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
11966 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
11967 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
11968 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
11969 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011970 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011971
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011972sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011973sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
11974sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
11975sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020011976 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
11977 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
11978 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
11979
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011980sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011981sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
11982sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
11983sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010011984 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
11985 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011986 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010011987 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
11988 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011989 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
11990 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
11991 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010011992
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011993so_id : integer
11994 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
11995 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
11996 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011997
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011998src : ip
11999 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
12000 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
12001 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
12002 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
12003 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" bind directive is used, it can
12004 be the address of a client behind another PROXY-protocol compatible component
12005 for all rule sets except "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012006
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012007 Example:
12008 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
12009 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
12010
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012011src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
12012 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
12013 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
12014 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012015 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012016
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012017src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
12018 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
12019 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012020 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012021 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012022
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012023src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
12024 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
12025 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
12026 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
12027 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
12028 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
12029 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020012030
12031 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
12032 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
12033 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
12034 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010012035 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020012036 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
12037 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
12038
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012039src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012040 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012041 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012042 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012043 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012044
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012045src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012046 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012047 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
12048 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012049 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012050
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012051src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
12052 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
12053 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
12054 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012055 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012056
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012057src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012058 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012059 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012060 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012061 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012062
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012063src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020012064 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012065 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020012066 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
12067 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012068 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
12069 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
12070 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020012071
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012072src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12073 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
12074 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012075 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012076 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012077 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012078
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012079src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
12080 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
12081 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
12082 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
12083 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012084 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012085
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012086src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12087 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
12088 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
12089 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012090 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012091
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012092src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
12093 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
12094 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
12095 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012096 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012097 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012098
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012099src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
12100 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
12101 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
12102 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012103 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012104 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
12105 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012106
12107 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010012108 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012109 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012110
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012111src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020012112 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
12113 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
12114 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
12115 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
12116 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012117
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012118src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020012119 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
12120 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
12121 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
12122 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
12123 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020012124
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012125src_port : integer
12126 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
12127 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
12128 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
12129 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010012130
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012131src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12132 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012133 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
12134 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
12135 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012136 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012137
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012138src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
12139 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
12140 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
12141 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
12142 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012143 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012144
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012145src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12146 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
12147 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
12148 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
12149 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
12150 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
12151 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
12152 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
12153 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020012154
12155 Example :
12156 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
12157 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
12158 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
12159 listen ssh
12160 bind :22
12161 mode tcp
12162 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012163 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012164 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020012165 server local 127.0.0.1:22
12166
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012167srv_id : integer
12168 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
12169 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
12170 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020012171
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +010012172
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200121737.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012174----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020012175
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012176The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
12177closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
12178when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
12179usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012180future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020012181
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020012182ssl_bc : boolean
12183 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
12184 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
12185 other a server with the "ssl" option.
12186
12187ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
12188 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
12189 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
12190
12191ssl_bc_cipher : string
12192 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
12193 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
12194
12195ssl_bc_protocol : string
12196 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
12197 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
12198
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020012199ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020012200 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020012201 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
12202 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020012203
12204ssl_bc_session_id : binary
12205 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
12206 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
12207 if session was reused or not.
12208
12209ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
12210 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
12211 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
12212
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012213ssl_c_ca_err : integer
12214 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
12215 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
12216 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
12217 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
12218 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020012219
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012220ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
12221 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
12222 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
12223 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
12224 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012225
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010012226ssl_c_der : binary
12227 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
12228 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
12229 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
12230
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012231ssl_c_err : integer
12232 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
12233 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
12234 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
12235 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
12236 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012237
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012238ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
12239 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
12240 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
12241 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
12242 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
12243 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
12244 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
12245 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
12246 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012247
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012248ssl_c_key_alg : string
12249 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
12250 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
12251 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012252
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012253ssl_c_notafter : string
12254 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
12255 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
12256 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020012257
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012258ssl_c_notbefore : string
12259 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
12260 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
12261 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010012262
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012263ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
12264 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
12265 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
12266 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
12267 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
12268 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
12269 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
12270 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
12271 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010012272
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012273ssl_c_serial : binary
12274 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
12275 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
12276 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020012277
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012278ssl_c_sha1 : binary
12279 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
12280 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
12281 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020012282 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
12283 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
12284
12285 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020012286
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012287ssl_c_sig_alg : string
12288 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
12289 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
12290 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020012291
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012292ssl_c_used : boolean
12293 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
12294 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020012295
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012296ssl_c_verify : integer
12297 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
12298 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
12299 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
12300 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020012301
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012302ssl_c_version : integer
12303 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
12304 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020012305
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010012306ssl_f_der : binary
12307 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
12308 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
12309 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
12310
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012311ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
12312 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
12313 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
12314 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
12315 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020012316 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012317 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
12318 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
12319 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020012320
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012321ssl_f_key_alg : string
12322 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
12323 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
12324 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020012325
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012326ssl_f_notafter : string
12327 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
12328 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
12329 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020012330
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012331ssl_f_notbefore : string
12332 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
12333 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
12334 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020012335
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012336ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
12337 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
12338 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
12339 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
12340 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
12341 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
12342 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
12343 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
12344 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020012345
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012346ssl_f_serial : binary
12347 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
12348 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
12349 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020012350
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020012351ssl_f_sha1 : binary
12352 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
12353 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
12354 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
12355
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012356ssl_f_sig_alg : string
12357 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
12358 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
12359 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020012360
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012361ssl_f_version : integer
12362 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
12363 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
12364
12365ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020012366 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
12367 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
12368 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
12369
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012370 Example :
12371 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
12372 listen http-https
12373 bind :80
12374 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
12375 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
12376
12377ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
12378 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
12379 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
12380
12381ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012382 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012383 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
12384 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
12385 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
12386 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
12387 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
12388 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
12389 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
12390 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
12391
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012392ssl_fc_cipher : string
12393 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
12394 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012395
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012396ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020012397 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
12398 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010012399 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
12400 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
12401 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
12402 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020012403
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012404ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
12405 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020012406 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
12407 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
12408 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
12409 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020012410
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020012411ssl_fc_is_resumed: boolean
12412 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
12413 SSL session cache or TLS tickets.
12414
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012415ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012416 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012417 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
12418 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
12419 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
12420 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
12421 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
12422 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
12423 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020012424
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012425ssl_fc_protocol : string
12426 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
12427 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020012428
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020012429ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040012430 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020012431 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
12432 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040012433
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012434ssl_fc_session_id : binary
12435 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
12436 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
12437 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
12438 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020012439
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012440ssl_fc_sni : string
12441 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
12442 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
12443 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
12444 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
12445 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
12446
12447 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
12448 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
12449 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020012450 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
12451 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012452
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012453 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012454 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
12455 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020012456
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012457ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
12458 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
12459 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020012460
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020012461
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200124627.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012463------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020012464
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012465Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
12466sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
12467only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
12468For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
12469be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
12470can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
12471sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
12472for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
12473content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012474
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012475payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
12476 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (eg:
12477 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
12478 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012479
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012480payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
12481 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
12482 (eg: "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
12483 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012484
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012485req.len : integer
12486req_len : integer (deprecated)
12487 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
12488 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
12489 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
12490 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
12491 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
12492 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
12493 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
12494 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020012495
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012496req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
12497 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020012498 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
12499 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
12500 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
12501 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020012502
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012503 ACL alternatives :
12504 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020012505
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012506req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
12507 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
12508 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
12509 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
12510 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020012511
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012512 ACL alternatives :
12513 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020012514
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012515 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020012516
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012517req.proto_http : boolean
12518req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
12519 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
12520 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
12521 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
12522 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
12523 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
12524 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
12525 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020012526
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012527 Example:
12528 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
12529 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
12530 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012531 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020012532
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012533req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
12534rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
12535 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
12536 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
12537 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
12538 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
12539 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
12540 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
12541 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020012542
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012543 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
12544 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
12545 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
12546 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
12547 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
12548 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020012549
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012550 ACL derivatives :
12551 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020012552
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012553 Example :
12554 listen tse-farm
12555 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
12556 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
12557 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
12558 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
12559 # apply RDP cookie persistence
12560 persist rdp-cookie
12561 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
12562 # This is only useful makes sense if
12563 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
12564 stick-table type string size 204800
12565 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
12566 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
12567 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020012568
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012569 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
12570 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020012571
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012572req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
12573rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
12574 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
12575 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
12576 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
12577 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020012578
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012579 ACL derivatives :
12580 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020012581
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012582req.ssl_hello_type : integer
12583req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
12584 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
12585 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
12586 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
12587 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
12588 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
12589 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
12590 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020012591
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012592req.ssl_sni : string
12593req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
12594 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
12595 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
12596 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
12597 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
12598 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
12599 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
12600 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
12601 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
12602 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
12603 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
12604 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
12605 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020012606
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012607 ACL derivatives :
12608 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020012609
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012610 Examples :
12611 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
12612 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
12613 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
12614 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
12615 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020012616
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012617res.ssl_hello_type : integer
12618rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
12619 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
12620 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
12621 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
12622 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
12623 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
12624 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
12625 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau51539362012-05-08 12:46:28 +020012626
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012627req.ssl_ver : integer
12628req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
12629 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
12630 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
12631 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
12632 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
12633 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
12634 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
12635 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
12636 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (eg: 3.1). This
12637 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012638
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012639 ACL derivatives :
12640 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012641
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020012642res.len : integer
12643 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
12644 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
12645 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
12646 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
12647 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
12648 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
12649 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
12650 content inspection.
12651
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012652res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
12653 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020012654 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
12655 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
12656 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
12657 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012658
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012659res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
12660 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
12661 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
12662 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
12663 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012664
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012665 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012666
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012667wait_end : boolean
12668 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
12669 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
12670 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
12671 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
12672 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
12673 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
12674 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
12675 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012676
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012677 Examples :
12678 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
12679 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
12680 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012681
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012682 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
12683 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
12684 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
12685 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
12686 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
12687 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
12688 tcp-request content reject
12689
12690
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200126917.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012692--------------------------------------
12693
12694It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
12695This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
12696data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
12697its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
12698HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
12699content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
12700to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
12701more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
12702response are indexed.
12703
12704base : string
12705 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
12706 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
12707 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
12708 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
12709 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
12710 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
12711 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
12712 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
12713
12714 ACL derivatives :
12715 base : exact string match
12716 base_beg : prefix match
12717 base_dir : subdir match
12718 base_dom : domain match
12719 base_end : suffix match
12720 base_len : length match
12721 base_reg : regex match
12722 base_sub : substring match
12723
12724base32 : integer
12725 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
12726 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
12727 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012728 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
12729 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
12730 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012731
12732base32+src : binary
12733 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
12734 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
12735 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
12736 per-URL counters.
12737
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010012738capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
12739 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
12740 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
12741 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
12742
12743capture.req.method : string
12744 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
12745 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
12746 because it's allocated.
12747
12748capture.req.uri : string
12749 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
12750 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
12751 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
12752 allocated.
12753
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020012754capture.req.ver : string
12755 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
12756 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
12757 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
12758
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010012759capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
12760 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
12761 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
12762 The first entry is an index of 0.
12763 See also: "capture response header"
12764
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020012765capture.res.ver : string
12766 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
12767 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
12768 persistent flag.
12769
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020012770req.body : binary
12771 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It
12772 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
12773 "option http-buffer-request". In case of chunked-encoded body, currently only
12774 the first chunk is analyzed.
12775
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020012776req.body_param([<name>) : string
12777 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
12778 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
12779 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
12780 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
12781 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
12782 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
12783 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
12784 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
12785 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
12786 given.
12787
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020012788req.body_len : integer
12789 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
12790 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
12791 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
12792 "option http-buffer-request".
12793
12794req.body_size : integer
12795 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
12796 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the first
12797 chunk in case of chunked encoding. In order to parse the chunks, it requires
12798 that the request body has been buffered made available using
12799 "option http-buffer-request".
12800
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012801req.cook([<name>]) : string
12802cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
12803 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
12804 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
12805 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
12806 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
12807 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
12808 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
12809 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
12810 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
12811
12812 ACL derivatives :
12813 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
12814 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
12815 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
12816 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
12817 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
12818 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
12819 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
12820 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012821
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012822req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
12823cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
12824 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
12825 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012826
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012827req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
12828cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
12829 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
12830 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
12831 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
12832 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020012833
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012834cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
12835 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
12836 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
12837 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
12838 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
12839 "appsession" does with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
12840 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
12841 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
12842 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
12843 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
12844 See also : "appsession".
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012845
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012846hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
12847 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
12848 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
12849 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
12850 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012851 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012852
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012853req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
12854 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
12855 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
12856 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
12857 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
12858 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
12859 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
12860 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
12861 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012862
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012863req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
12864 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
12865 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
12866 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
12867 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012868
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012869req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
12870 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
12871 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
12872 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
12873 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
12874 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
12875 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
12876 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
12877 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
12878 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC2616 to know
12879 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
12880 insensitive (eg: Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012881
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012882 ACL derivatives :
12883 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
12884 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
12885 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
12886 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
12887 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
12888 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
12889 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
12890 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
12891
12892req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
12893hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
12894 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
12895 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
12896 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
12897 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
12898 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
12899 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
12900 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
12901 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
12902 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
12903
12904req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
12905hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
12906 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
12907 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
12908 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
12909 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
12910 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
12911 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
12912 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
12913 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
12914
12915req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
12916hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
12917 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
12918 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
12919 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
12920 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
12921 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
12922 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
12923 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
12924
12925http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
12926 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
12927 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
12928 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
12929 basic auth is supported.
12930
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010012931http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
12932 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
12933 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
12934 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
12935 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012936 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
12937 basic auth is supported.
12938
12939 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010012940 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
12941 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
12942 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
12943 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012944
12945http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020012946 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
12947 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012948 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
12949 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020012950
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012951method : integer + string
12952 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
12953 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
12954 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
12955 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
12956 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
12957 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
12958 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012959
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012960 ACL derivatives :
12961 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012962
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012963 Example :
12964 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
12965 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
12966 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012967
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012968path : string
12969 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
12970 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
12971 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
12972 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
12973 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
12974 used to match exact file names (eg: "/login.php"), or directory parts using
12975 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012976
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012977 ACL derivatives :
12978 path : exact string match
12979 path_beg : prefix match
12980 path_dir : subdir match
12981 path_dom : domain match
12982 path_end : suffix match
12983 path_len : length match
12984 path_reg : regex match
12985 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012986
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010012987query : string
12988 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
12989 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
12990 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
12991 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
12992 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the completemnt of "path"
12993 which stops before the question mark.
12994
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010012995req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
12996 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
12997 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
12998 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
12999 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
13000
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013001req.ver : string
13002req_ver : string (deprecated)
13003 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
13004 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
13005 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013006
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013007 ACL derivatives :
13008 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020013009
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013010res.comp : boolean
13011 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
13012 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
13013 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013014
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013015res.comp_algo : string
13016 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
13017 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
13018 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013019
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013020res.cook([<name>]) : string
13021scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
13022 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
13023 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
13024 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020013025
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013026 ACL derivatives :
13027 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020013028
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013029res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
13030scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
13031 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
13032 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
13033 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013034
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013035res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
13036scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
13037 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
13038 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
13039 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013040
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013041res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
13042 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
13043 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
13044 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
13045 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
13046 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
13047 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
13048 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
13049 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
13050 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013051
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013052res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
13053 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
13054 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
13055 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
13056 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
13057 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013058
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013059res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
13060shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
13061 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
13062 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
13063 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
13064 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
13065 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
13066 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
13067 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
13068 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013069
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013070 ACL derivatives :
13071 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
13072 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
13073 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
13074 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
13075 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
13076 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
13077 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
13078 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
13079
13080res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
13081shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
13082 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
13083 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
13084 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
13085 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
13086 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013087
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013088res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
13089shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
13090 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
13091 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
13092 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
13093 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
13094 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
13095 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013096
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010013097res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
13098 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
13099 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
13100 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
13101 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
13102
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013103res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
13104shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
13105 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
13106 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
13107 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
13108 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
13109 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
13110 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010013111
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013112res.ver : string
13113resp_ver : string (deprecated)
13114 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
13115 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020013116
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013117 ACL derivatives :
13118 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010013119
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013120set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
13121 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
13122 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
13123 can be comparable to what "appsession" does with default options, but with
13124 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010013125
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013126 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
13127 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010013128
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013129 See also : "appsession"
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020013130
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013131status : integer
13132 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
13133 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
13134 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020013135
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013136url : string
13137 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
13138 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
13139 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
13140 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
13141 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
13142 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
13143 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020013144
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013145 ACL derivatives :
13146 url : exact string match
13147 url_beg : prefix match
13148 url_dir : subdir match
13149 url_dom : domain match
13150 url_end : suffix match
13151 url_len : length match
13152 url_reg : regex match
13153 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020013154
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013155url_ip : ip
13156 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
13157 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
13158 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
13159 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
13160 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
13161 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
13162 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020013163
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013164url_port : integer
13165 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
13166 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
13167 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
13168 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020013169
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020013170urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
13171url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013172 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
13173 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020013174 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
13175 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
13176 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
13177 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013178 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
13179 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020013180 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
13181 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020013182
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013183 ACL derivatives :
13184 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
13185 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
13186 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
13187 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
13188 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
13189 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
13190 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
13191 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020013192
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020013193
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013194 Example :
13195 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
13196 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
13197 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
13198 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020013199
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020013200urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>])] : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013201 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
13202 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
13203 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020013204
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010013205
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200132067.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013207---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010013208
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013209Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
13210every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020013211order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010013212
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013213ACL name Equivalent to Usage
13214---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013215FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020013216HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013217HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
13218HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013219HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
13220HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
13221HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
13222HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
13223LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013224METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
13225METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
13226METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
13227METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
13228METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
13229METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020013230RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013231REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013232TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013233WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
13234---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010013235
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010013236
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200132378. Logging
13238----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013239
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013240One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
13241provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
13242very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
13243provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
13244state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013245to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013246headers.
13247
13248In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
13249about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
13250send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
13251
13252 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
13253 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
13254 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
13255 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
13256 at the termination.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060013257 - per-request control of log-level, eg:
13258 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013259
13260The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
13261allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
13262as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
13263while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
13264real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
13265delay.
13266
13267
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200132688.1. Log levels
13269---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013270
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090013271TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013272source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090013273HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
13274in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
13275track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
13276syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
13277about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013278
13279
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200132808.2. Log formats
13281----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013282
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013283HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090013284and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
13285slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
13286options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013287
13288 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
13289 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
13290 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
13291 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
13292 extents.
13293
13294 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
13295 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
13296 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
13297 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
13298 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
13299
13300 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
13301 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
13302 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
13303 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
13304 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
13305
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020013306 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
13307 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
13308 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
13309 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
13310
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013311 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
13312
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013313Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
13314specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
13315field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
13316servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
13317always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
13318identifier.
13319
13320Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
13321 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
13322 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
13323 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
13324 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
13325
13326
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200133278.2.1. Default log format
13328-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013329
13330This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
13331as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
13332format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
13333
13334 Example :
13335 listen www
13336 mode http
13337 log global
13338 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
13339
13340 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
13341 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
13342 (www/HTTP)
13343
13344 Field Format Extract from the example above
13345 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
13346 2 'Connect from' Connect from
13347 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
13348 4 'to' to
13349 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
13350 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
13351
13352Detailed fields description :
13353 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
13354 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
13355 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
13356 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
13357 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
13358 and processed the connection.
13359 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
13360
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010013361In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
13362"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
13363connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
13364
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013365It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
13366will eventually disappear.
13367
13368
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200133698.2.2. TCP log format
13370---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013371
13372The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
13373is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
13374information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
13375counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
13376emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
13377environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
13378the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
13379sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020013380specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
13381not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
13382fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
13383marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013384
13385 Example :
13386 frontend fnt
13387 mode tcp
13388 option tcplog
13389 log global
13390 default_backend bck
13391
13392 backend bck
13393 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
13394
13395 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
13396 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
13397 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
13398
13399 Field Format Extract from the example above
13400 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
13401 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
13402 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
13403 4 frontend_name fnt
13404 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
13405 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
13406 7 bytes_read* 212
13407 8 termination_state --
13408 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
13409 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
13410
13411Detailed fields description :
13412 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010013413 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
13414 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
13415 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
13416 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
13417 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013418
13419 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010013420 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
13421 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
13422 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013423
13424 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
13425 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
13426 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
13427 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
13428
13429 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
13430 and processed the connection.
13431
13432 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
13433 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
13434 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
13435 applications.
13436
13437 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
13438 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
13439 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
13440 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
13441 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
13442
13443 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
13444 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
13445 See "Timers" below for more details.
13446
13447 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
13448 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
13449 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
13450 "Timers" below for more details.
13451
13452 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013453 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013454 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
13455 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
13456 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
13457 details.
13458
13459 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
13460 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
13461 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
13462 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
13463 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
13464
13465 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
13466 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
13467 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
13468 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
13469 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
13470 for more details.
13471
13472 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013473 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013474 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
13475 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
13476 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013477 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013478
13479 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
13480 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
13481 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
13482 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
13483 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
13484 caused by a denial of service attack.
13485
13486 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
13487 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
13488 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
13489 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
13490 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
13491 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
13492 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
13493 denial of service attack.
13494
13495 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
13496 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
13497 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
13498 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
13499 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
13500 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
13501 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
13502 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
13503 be processed than on other servers.
13504
13505 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
13506 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
13507 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
13508 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
13509 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
13510 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
13511 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
13512 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
13513 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
13514 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
13515 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
13516 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
13517 should not be attributed to the logged server.
13518
13519 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
13520 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
13521 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
13522 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
13523 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
13524 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
13525 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
13526 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
13527
13528 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
13529 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
13530 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
13531 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
13532 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
13533 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
13534 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
13535 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
13536 occurs.
13537
13538
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200135398.2.3. HTTP log format
13540----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013541
13542The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
13543is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
13544the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
13545are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
13546emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
13547generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
13548"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
13549which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020013550frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
13551is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013552
13553Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
13554slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
13555with a star ('*') after the field name below.
13556
13557 Example :
13558 frontend http-in
13559 mode http
13560 option httplog
13561 log global
13562 default_backend bck
13563
13564 backend static
13565 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
13566
13567 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
13568 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
13569 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013570 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013571
13572 Field Format Extract from the example above
13573 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
13574 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
13575 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
13576 4 frontend_name http-in
13577 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
13578 6 Tq '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Tt* 10/0/30/69/109
13579 7 status_code 200
13580 8 bytes_read* 2750
13581 9 captured_request_cookie -
13582 10 captured_response_cookie -
13583 11 termination_state ----
13584 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
13585 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
13586 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
13587 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
13588 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013589
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013590
13591Detailed fields description :
13592 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010013593 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
13594 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
13595 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
13596 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
13597 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013598
13599 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010013600 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
13601 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
13602 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013603
13604 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the TCP connection was received by
13605 haproxy (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on
13606 the network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is
13607 usually the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. This
13608 does not depend on the fact that the client has sent the request or not.
13609
13610 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
13611 and processed the connection.
13612
13613 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
13614 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
13615 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
13616
13617 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
13618 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
13619 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
13620 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
13621 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
13622 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
13623
13624 - "Tq" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the client to send
13625 a full HTTP request, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the connection
13626 was aborted before a complete request could be received. It should always
13627 be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet. Large
13628 times here generally indicate network trouble between the client and
13629 haproxy. See "Timers" below for more details.
13630
13631 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
13632 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
13633 See "Timers" below for more details.
13634
13635 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
13636 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
13637 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
13638 below for more details.
13639
13640 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
13641 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
13642 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
13643 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
13644 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
13645 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
13646 for more details.
13647
13648 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013649 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013650 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
13651 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
13652 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
13653 details.
13654
13655 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
13656 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
13657 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
13658
13659 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
13660 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
13661 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
13662 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
13663 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
13664 overflowing.
13665
13666 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
13667 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
13668 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
13669 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
13670 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
13671 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
13672 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
13673 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
13674
13675 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
13676 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
13677 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
13678 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
13679 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
13680 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
13681 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
13682 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
13683
13684 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
13685 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
13686 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
13687 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
13688 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
13689 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
13690 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
13691
13692 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013693 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013694 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
13695 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
13696 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013697 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013698 system.
13699
13700 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
13701 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
13702 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
13703 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
13704 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
13705 caused by a denial of service attack.
13706
13707 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
13708 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
13709 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
13710 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
13711 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
13712 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
13713 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
13714 denial of service attack.
13715
13716 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
13717 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
13718 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
13719 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
13720 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
13721 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
13722 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
13723 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
13724 processed than on other servers.
13725
13726 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
13727 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
13728 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
13729 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
13730 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
13731 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
13732 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
13733 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
13734 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
13735 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
13736 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
13737 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
13738 should not be attributed to the logged server.
13739
13740 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
13741 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
13742 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
13743 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
13744 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
13745 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
13746 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
13747 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
13748
13749 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
13750 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
13751 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
13752 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
13753 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
13754 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
13755 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
13756 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
13757 occurs.
13758
13759 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
13760 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
13761 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
13762 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
13763 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
13764 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
13765 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
13766 cookies" below for more details.
13767
13768 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
13769 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
13770 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
13771 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
13772 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
13773 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
13774 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
13775 and cookies" below for more details.
13776
13777 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
13778 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
13779 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
13780 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
13781 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
13782 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
13783 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
13784 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
13785
13786
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200137878.2.4. Custom log format
13788------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013789
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013790The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013791mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013792
13793HAproxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
13794Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
13795separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
13796prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
13797
13798Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
13799variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
13800string formats ("Q").
13801
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010013802If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020013803as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010013804less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
13805the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
13806
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013807Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013808In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010013809in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013810
13811Flags are :
13812 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013813 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013814
13815 Example:
13816
13817 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
13818 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
13819
13820At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
13821
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013822 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tq/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Tt\ %ST\ %B\ %CC\ \
13823 %CS\ %tsc\ %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq\ %hr\ %hs\ %{+Q}r
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013824
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013825the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013826
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013827 log-format %{+Q}o\ %{-Q}ci\ -\ -\ [%T]\ %r\ %ST\ %B\ \"\"\ \"\"\ %cp\ \
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020013828 %ms\ %ft\ %b\ %s\ \%Tq\ %Tw\ %Tc\ %Tr\ %Tt\ %tsc\ %ac\ %fc\ \
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013829 %bc\ %sc\ %rc\ %sq\ %bq\ %CC\ %CS\ \%hrl\ %hsl
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013830
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013831and the default TCP format is defined this way :
13832
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013833 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tw/%Tc/%Tt\ %B\ %ts\ \
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013834 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq
13835
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013836Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
13837
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013838 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020013839 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013840 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
13841 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
13842 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013843 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
13844 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
13845 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020013846 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000013847 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
13848 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
13849 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
13850 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013851 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020013852 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020013853 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013854 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080013855 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020013856 | H | %Tq | Tq | numeric |
13857 | H | %Tr | Tr | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020013858 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013859 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
13860 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013861 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013862 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
13863 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013864 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
13865 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
13866 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013867 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013868 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
13869 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013870 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013871 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
13872 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
13873 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020013874 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020013875 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020013876 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
13877 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
13878 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
13879 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013880 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020013881 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020013882 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013883 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010013884 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013885 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013886 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
13887 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
13888 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013889 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020013890 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
13891 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013892 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013893 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020013894 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013895 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013896
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020013897 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013898
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010013899
139008.2.5. Error log format
13901-----------------------
13902
13903When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
13904protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
13905By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
13906"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
13907will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (eg: probes) are not
13908logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
13909
13910The format looks like this :
13911
13912 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
13913 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
13914 Connection error during SSL handshake
13915
13916 Field Format Extract from the example above
13917 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
13918 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
13919 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
13920 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
13921 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
13922
13923These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
13924failures.
13925
13926
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200139278.3. Advanced logging options
13928-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013929
13930Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
13931just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
13932options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
13933for more information about their usage.
13934
13935
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200139368.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
13937------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013938
13939It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
13940haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
13941commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
13942monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
13943ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
13944
13945 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
13946 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
13947 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
13948 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
13949
13950 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
13951 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
13952 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013953 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013954 such as other load-balancers.
13955
13956 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
13957 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
13958 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
13959
13960
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200139618.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
13962----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013963
13964The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
13965what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
13966or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
13967"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
13968just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
13969log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
13970after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
13971is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
13972with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
13973with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
13974
13975
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200139768.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
13977------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020013978
13979Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
13980for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
13981"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
13982retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
13983raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
13984a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
13985file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
13986you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
13987"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
13988
13989
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200139908.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
13991--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020013992
13993Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
13994multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
13995them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
13996"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
13997logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
13998error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
13999and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
14000too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
14001useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
14002alternative.
14003
14004
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200140058.4. Timing events
14006------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014007
14008Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
14009reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
14010the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
14011frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
14012mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/Tt" :
14013
14014 - Tq: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
14015 elapsed between the moment the client connection was accepted and the
14016 moment the proxy received the last HTTP header. The value "-1" indicates
14017 that the end of headers (empty line) has never been seen. This happens when
14018 the client closes prematurely or times out.
14019
14020 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
14021 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
14022 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
14023 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
14024 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
14025
14026 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
14027 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
14028 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
14029 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
14030 connection never established.
14031
14032 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
14033 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
14034 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
14035 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
14036 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
14037 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
14038 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
14039 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
14040 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
14041 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
14042 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
14043
14044 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
14045 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
14046 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Tq+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
14047 prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014048 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014049
14050 Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr)
14051
14052 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
14053 mode, "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never be
14054 negative.
14055
14056These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
14057protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
14058that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014059due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Tt" is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014060close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means that a
14061session has been aborted on timeout.
14062
14063Most common cases :
14064
14065 - If "Tq" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
14066 client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might happen
14067 when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It may
14068 happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network cause.
14069 Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has ended,
14070 haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds. The time
14071 spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay processing
14072 of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the order of
14073 a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of new
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020014074 connections have been accepted at once. Setting "option http-server-close"
14075 may display larger request times since "Tq" also measures the time spent
14076 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014077
14078 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
14079 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
14080 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
14081 of ms on remote networks.
14082
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014083 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
14084 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
14085 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014086
14087 - If "Tt" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
14088 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection, for
14089 instance because both have agreed on a keep-alive connection mode. In order
14090 to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify "option httpclose" on
14091 either the frontend or the backend. If the problem persists, it means that
14092 the server ignores the "close" connection mode and expects the client to
14093 close. Then it will be required to use "option forceclose". Having the
14094 smallest possible 'Tt' is important when connection regulation is used with
14095 the "maxconn" option on the servers, since no new connection will be sent
14096 to the server until another one is released.
14097
14098Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
14099
14100 Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Tt The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
14101 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
14102 except "Tt" which is shorter than reality.
14103
14104 -1/xx/xx/xx/Tt The client was not able to send a complete request in time
14105 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
14106 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
14107
14108 Tq/-1/xx/xx/Tt It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
14109 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
14110 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
14111 flags.
14112
14113 Tq/Tw/-1/xx/Tt The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
14114 actively refused it or it timed out after Tt-(Tq+Tw) ms.
14115 Check the session termination flags, then check the
14116 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
14117 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
14118 the client connection was maintained open.
14119
14120 Tq/Tw/Tc/-1/Tt The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014121 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014122 unexpectedly after Tt-(Tq+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
14123 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
14124
14125
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200141268.5. Session state at disconnection
14127-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014128
14129TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
14130"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
141312-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
14132each of which has a special meaning :
14133
14134 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
14135 session to terminate :
14136
14137 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
14138
14139 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
14140 server explicitly refused it.
14141
14142 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
14143 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
14144 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
14145 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020014146 (eg: cacheable cookie).
14147
14148 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
14149 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014150
14151 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
14152 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
14153 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
14154 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
14155 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
14156
14157 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
14158 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
14159 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
14160 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
14161 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
14162
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090014163 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
14164 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
14165
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014166 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
14167 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
14168 backup connections when going up.
14169
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020014170 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
14171
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014172 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
14173 send or receive data.
14174
14175 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
14176 send or receive data.
14177
14178 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
14179 with nothing left in the buffers.
14180
14181 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
14182
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010014183 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014184 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
14185
14186 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
14187 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
14188 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
14189 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
14190 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
14191
14192 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
14193 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
14194
14195 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
14196 server (HTTP only).
14197
14198 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
14199
14200 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
14201 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
14202 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
14203
14204 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
14205 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
14206 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
14207
14208 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
14209
14210 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
14211 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
14212
14213 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
14214 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
14215 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
14216
14217 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
14218 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020014219 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
14220 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014221
14222 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
14223 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
14224 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
14225 another server.
14226
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020014227 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014228 server.
14229
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020014230 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
14231 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
14232 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
14233 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
14234
14235 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
14236 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
14237 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
14238 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
14239
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020014240 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
14241 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
14242 "use-server" rule).
14243
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014244 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
14245
14246 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
14247 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
14248
14249 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
14250
14251 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
14252 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
14253 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
14254
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020014255 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
14256 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014257 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020014258 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
14259 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
14260
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014261 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
14262
14263 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
14264 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
14265
14266 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
14267
14268 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
14269
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020014270The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
14271was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014272helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
14273starvation, attacks, etc...
14274
14275The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
14276alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
14277easier finding and understanding.
14278
14279 Flags Reason
14280
14281 -- Normal termination.
14282
14283 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
14284 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
14285 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
14286 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
14287
14288 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
14289 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
14290 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
14291 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
14292 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
14293 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014294
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014295 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
14296 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020014297 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014298
14299 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
14300 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
14301 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
14302
14303 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
14304 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
14305 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
14306 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
14307 the server takes too long to respond.
14308
14309 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
14310 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
14311 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
14312 long a time to respond.
14313
14314 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
14315 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
14316 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
14317 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020014318 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
14319 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014320
14321 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
14322 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
14323 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
14324 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
14325 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020014326 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020014327 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
14328 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
14329 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
14330 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
14331 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
14332 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
14333 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
14334 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
14335 around the undesirable effects of this behaviour by adding "option
14336 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
14337 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
14338 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014339
14340 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
14341 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014342 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
14343 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
14344 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
14345 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014346
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020014347 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
14348 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
14349
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014350 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014351 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
14352 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
14353 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
14354 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
14355 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
14356
14357 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
14358 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
14359 503 or 504 here.
14360
14361 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
14362 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
14363 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
14364 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
14365 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
14366
14367 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
14368 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014369 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014370 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
14371 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
14372
14373 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
14374 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
14375 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
14376 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
14377 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
14378 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
14379 between haproxy and the server.
14380
14381 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
14382 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
14383 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
14384 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
14385 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
14386 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
14387 solution is to fix the application.
14388
14389 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
14390 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
14391 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
14392 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
14393 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
14394 external attacks.
14395
14396 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
14397 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020014398 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014399 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
14400 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
14401
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010014402 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
14403 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
14404 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020014405 the client. Haproxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
14406 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010014407
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014408 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
14409 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
14410 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
14411 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010014412 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
14413 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
14414 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
14415 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
14416 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014417
14418 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
14419 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
14420 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
14421 returned an HTTP 403 error.
14422
14423 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
14424 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
14425 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
14426 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
14427
14428 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
14429 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
14430 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
14431 only be solved by proper system tuning.
14432
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020014433The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
14434persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
14435important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
14436re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
14437
14438 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
14439
14440 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
14441 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
14442 set on a GET request.
14443
14444 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
14445 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014446 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020014447 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
14448
14449 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
14450 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
14451 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
14452
14453 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
14454 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
14455 already got a cookie.
14456
14457 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
14458 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
14459 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
14460 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
14461 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
14462
14463 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
14464 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
14465 new cookie was inserted in the response.
14466
14467 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
14468 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
14469 new cookie was inserted in the response.
14470
14471 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
14472 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
14473
14474 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
14475 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
14476 then advertised in the response.
14477
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014478
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200144798.6. Non-printable characters
14480-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014481
14482In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
14483consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
14484converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
14485prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
14486being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
14487escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
14488is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
14489'}' when logging headers.
14490
14491Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
14492issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
14493containing spaces is "User-Agent".
14494
14495Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
14496the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
14497performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
14498
14499
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200145008.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
14501---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014502
14503Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
14504achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014505section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014506cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
14507the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
14508the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014509locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014510not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
14511user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
14512a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
14513wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
14514
14515 Examples :
14516 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
14517 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
14518
14519 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
14520 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
14521
14522
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200145238.8. Capturing HTTP headers
14524---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014525
14526Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
14527proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
14528the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
14529server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
14530
14531Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
14532response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014533section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014534
14535It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014536time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
14537appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014538are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
14539and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
14540follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
14541request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
14542in the logs.
14543
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020014544As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
14545frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
14546an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
14547
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014548 Example :
14549 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
14550 listen proxy-out
14551 mode http
14552 option httplog
14553 option logasap
14554 log global
14555 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
14556
14557 # log the name of the virtual server
14558 capture request header Host len 20
14559
14560 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
14561 capture request header Content-Length len 10
14562
14563 # log the beginning of the referrer
14564 capture request header Referer len 20
14565
14566 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
14567 capture response header Server len 20
14568
14569 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
14570 capture response header Content-Length len 10
14571
14572 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
14573 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
14574
14575 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
14576 capture response header Via len 20
14577
14578 # log the URL location during a redirection
14579 capture response header Location len 20
14580
14581 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
14582 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
14583 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
14584 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
14585 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
14586
14587 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
14588 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
14589 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
14590 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014591 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014592
14593 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
14594 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
14595 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
14596 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
14597 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014598 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014599
14600
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200146018.9. Examples of logs
14602---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014603
14604These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
14605them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
14606reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
14607
14608 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
14609 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
14610 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
14611
14612 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
14613 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
14614
14615 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
14616 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
14617 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
14618
14619 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
14620 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
14621
14622 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
14623 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
14624 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
14625
14626 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014627 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014628 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
14629 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
14630
14631 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
14632 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
14633 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
14634
14635 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
14636 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020014637 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014638 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
14639 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
14640 to return the 502 and not the server.
14641
14642 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014643 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014644
14645 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
14646 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
14647 Nothing was sent to any server.
14648
14649 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
14650 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
14651
14652 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
14653 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
14654 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
14655 send a 408 return code to the client.
14656
14657 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
14658 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
14659
14660 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
14661 5 seconds ("c----").
14662
14663 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
14664 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014665 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014666
14667 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014668 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014669 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
14670 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
14671 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
14672 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
14673 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014674
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010014675
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200146769. Statistics and monitoring
14677----------------------------
14678
14679It is possible to query HAProxy about its status. The most commonly used
14680mechanism is the HTTP statistics page. This page also exposes an alternative
14681CSV output format for monitoring tools. The same format is provided on the
14682Unix socket.
14683
14684
146859.1. CSV format
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010014686---------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010014687
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +010014688The statistics may be consulted either from the unix socket or from the HTTP
Willy Tarreaua3310dc2014-06-16 15:43:21 +020014689page. Both means provide a CSV format whose fields follow. The first line
14690begins with a sharp ('#') and has one word per comma-delimited field which
14691represents the title of the column. All other lines starting at the second one
14692use a classical CSV format using a comma as the delimiter, and the double quote
14693('"') as an optional text delimiter, but only if the enclosed text is ambiguous
14694(if it contains a quote or a comma). The double-quote character ('"') in the
14695text is doubled ('""'), which is the format that most tools recognize. Please
14696do not insert any column before these ones in order not to break tools which
14697use hard-coded column positions.
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +010014698
James Westbyebe62d62014-07-08 10:14:57 -040014699In brackets after each field name are the types which may have a value for
14700that field. The types are L (Listeners), F (Frontends), B (Backends), and
14701S (Servers).
14702
14703 0. pxname [LFBS]: proxy name
14704 1. svname [LFBS]: service name (FRONTEND for frontend, BACKEND for backend,
14705 any name for server/listener)
14706 2. qcur [..BS]: current queued requests. For the backend this reports the
14707 number queued without a server assigned.
14708 3. qmax [..BS]: max value of qcur
14709 4. scur [LFBS]: current sessions
14710 5. smax [LFBS]: max sessions
14711 6. slim [LFBS]: configured session limit
14712 7. stot [LFBS]: cumulative number of connections
14713 8. bin [LFBS]: bytes in
14714 9. bout [LFBS]: bytes out
14715 10. dreq [LFB.]: requests denied because of security concerns.
14716 - For tcp this is because of a matched tcp-request content rule.
14717 - For http this is because of a matched http-request or tarpit rule.
14718 11. dresp [LFBS]: responses denied because of security concerns.
14719 - For http this is because of a matched http-request rule, or
14720 "option checkcache".
14721 12. ereq [LF..]: request errors. Some of the possible causes are:
14722 - early termination from the client, before the request has been sent.
14723 - read error from the client
14724 - client timeout
14725 - client closed connection
14726 - various bad requests from the client.
14727 - request was tarpitted.
14728 13. econ [..BS]: number of requests that encountered an error trying to
14729 connect to a backend server. The backend stat is the sum of the stat
14730 for all servers of that backend, plus any connection errors not
14731 associated with a particular server (such as the backend having no
14732 active servers).
14733 14. eresp [..BS]: response errors. srv_abrt will be counted here also.
14734 Some other errors are:
14735 - write error on the client socket (won't be counted for the server stat)
14736 - failure applying filters to the response.
14737 15. wretr [..BS]: number of times a connection to a server was retried.
14738 16. wredis [..BS]: number of times a request was redispatched to another
14739 server. The server value counts the number of times that server was
14740 switched away from.
14741 17. status [LFBS]: status (UP/DOWN/NOLB/MAINT/MAINT(via)...)
Pavlos Parissis1f673c72015-05-02 20:30:44 +020014742 18. weight [..BS]: total weight (backend), server weight (server)
14743 19. act [..BS]: number of active servers (backend), server is active (server)
14744 20. bck [..BS]: number of backup servers (backend), server is backup (server)
James Westbyebe62d62014-07-08 10:14:57 -040014745 21. chkfail [...S]: number of failed checks. (Only counts checks failed when
14746 the server is up.)
14747 22. chkdown [..BS]: number of UP->DOWN transitions. The backend counter counts
14748 transitions to the whole backend being down, rather than the sum of the
14749 counters for each server.
14750 23. lastchg [..BS]: number of seconds since the last UP<->DOWN transition
14751 24. downtime [..BS]: total downtime (in seconds). The value for the backend
14752 is the downtime for the whole backend, not the sum of the server downtime.
14753 25. qlimit [...S]: configured maxqueue for the server, or nothing in the
14754 value is 0 (default, meaning no limit)
14755 26. pid [LFBS]: process id (0 for first instance, 1 for second, ...)
14756 27. iid [LFBS]: unique proxy id
14757 28. sid [L..S]: server id (unique inside a proxy)
14758 29. throttle [...S]: current throttle percentage for the server, when
14759 slowstart is active, or no value if not in slowstart.
14760 30. lbtot [..BS]: total number of times a server was selected, either for new
14761 sessions, or when re-dispatching. The server counter is the number
14762 of times that server was selected.
14763 31. tracked [...S]: id of proxy/server if tracking is enabled.
14764 32. type [LFBS]: (0=frontend, 1=backend, 2=server, 3=socket/listener)
14765 33. rate [.FBS]: number of sessions per second over last elapsed second
14766 34. rate_lim [.F..]: configured limit on new sessions per second
14767 35. rate_max [.FBS]: max number of new sessions per second
14768 36. check_status [...S]: status of last health check, one of:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010014769 UNK -> unknown
14770 INI -> initializing
14771 SOCKERR -> socket error
14772 L4OK -> check passed on layer 4, no upper layers testing enabled
Jason Harvey83104802015-04-16 11:13:21 -080014773 L4TOUT -> layer 1-4 timeout
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010014774 L4CON -> layer 1-4 connection problem, for example
14775 "Connection refused" (tcp rst) or "No route to host" (icmp)
14776 L6OK -> check passed on layer 6
14777 L6TOUT -> layer 6 (SSL) timeout
14778 L6RSP -> layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
14779 L7OK -> check passed on layer 7
14780 L7OKC -> check conditionally passed on layer 7, for example 404 with
14781 disable-on-404
14782 L7TOUT -> layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
14783 L7RSP -> layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
14784 L7STS -> layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
James Westbyebe62d62014-07-08 10:14:57 -040014785 37. check_code [...S]: layer5-7 code, if available
14786 38. check_duration [...S]: time in ms took to finish last health check
14787 39. hrsp_1xx [.FBS]: http responses with 1xx code
14788 40. hrsp_2xx [.FBS]: http responses with 2xx code
14789 41. hrsp_3xx [.FBS]: http responses with 3xx code
14790 42. hrsp_4xx [.FBS]: http responses with 4xx code
14791 43. hrsp_5xx [.FBS]: http responses with 5xx code
14792 44. hrsp_other [.FBS]: http responses with other codes (protocol error)
14793 45. hanafail [...S]: failed health checks details
14794 46. req_rate [.F..]: HTTP requests per second over last elapsed second
14795 47. req_rate_max [.F..]: max number of HTTP requests per second observed
14796 48. req_tot [.F..]: total number of HTTP requests received
14797 49. cli_abrt [..BS]: number of data transfers aborted by the client
14798 50. srv_abrt [..BS]: number of data transfers aborted by the server
14799 (inc. in eresp)
14800 51. comp_in [.FB.]: number of HTTP response bytes fed to the compressor
14801 52. comp_out [.FB.]: number of HTTP response bytes emitted by the compressor
14802 53. comp_byp [.FB.]: number of bytes that bypassed the HTTP compressor
14803 (CPU/BW limit)
14804 54. comp_rsp [.FB.]: number of HTTP responses that were compressed
14805 55. lastsess [..BS]: number of seconds since last session assigned to
14806 server/backend
14807 56. last_chk [...S]: last health check contents or textual error
14808 57. last_agt [...S]: last agent check contents or textual error
14809 58. qtime [..BS]: the average queue time in ms over the 1024 last requests
14810 59. ctime [..BS]: the average connect time in ms over the 1024 last requests
14811 60. rtime [..BS]: the average response time in ms over the 1024 last requests
14812 (0 for TCP)
14813 61. ttime [..BS]: the average total session time in ms over the 1024 last
14814 requests
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014815
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010014816
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200148179.2. Unix Socket commands
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010014818-------------------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010014819
Willy Tarreau468f4932013-08-01 16:50:16 +020014820The stats socket is not enabled by default. In order to enable it, it is
14821necessary to add one line in the global section of the haproxy configuration.
14822A second line is recommended to set a larger timeout, always appreciated when
14823issuing commands by hand :
14824
14825 global
14826 stats socket /var/run/haproxy.sock mode 600 level admin
14827 stats timeout 2m
14828
14829It is also possible to add multiple instances of the stats socket by repeating
14830the line, and make them listen to a TCP port instead of a UNIX socket. This is
14831never done by default because this is dangerous, but can be handy in some
14832situations :
14833
14834 global
14835 stats socket /var/run/haproxy.sock mode 600 level admin
14836 stats socket ipv4@192.168.0.1:9999 level admin
14837 stats timeout 2m
14838
14839To access the socket, an external utility such as "socat" is required. Socat is a
14840swiss-army knife to connect anything to anything. We use it to connect terminals
14841to the socket, or a couple of stdin/stdout pipes to it for scripts. The two main
14842syntaxes we'll use are the following :
14843
14844 # socat /var/run/haproxy.sock stdio
14845 # socat /var/run/haproxy.sock readline
14846
14847The first one is used with scripts. It is possible to send the output of a
14848script to haproxy, and pass haproxy's output to another script. That's useful
14849for retrieving counters or attack traces for example.
14850
14851The second one is only useful for issuing commands by hand. It has the benefit
14852that the terminal is handled by the readline library which supports line
14853editing and history, which is very convenient when issuing repeated commands
14854(eg: watch a counter).
14855
14856The socket supports two operation modes :
14857 - interactive
14858 - non-interactive
14859
14860The non-interactive mode is the default when socat connects to the socket. In
14861this mode, a single line may be sent. It is processed as a whole, responses are
14862sent back, and the connection closes after the end of the response. This is the
14863mode that scripts and monitoring tools use. It is possible to send multiple
14864commands in this mode, they need to be delimited by a semi-colon (';'). For
14865example :
14866
14867 # echo "show info;show stat;show table" | socat /var/run/haproxy stdio
14868
14869The interactive mode displays a prompt ('>') and waits for commands to be
14870entered on the line, then processes them, and displays the prompt again to wait
14871for a new command. This mode is entered via the "prompt" command which must be
14872sent on the first line in non-interactive mode. The mode is a flip switch, if
14873"prompt" is sent in interactive mode, it is disabled and the connection closes
14874after processing the last command of the same line.
14875
14876For this reason, when debugging by hand, it's quite common to start with the
14877"prompt" command :
14878
14879 # socat /var/run/haproxy readline
14880 prompt
14881 > show info
14882 ...
14883 >
14884
14885Since multiple commands may be issued at once, haproxy uses the empty line as a
14886delimiter to mark an end of output for each command, and takes care of ensuring
14887that no command can emit an empty line on output. A script can thus easily
14888parse the output even when multiple commands were pipelined on a single line.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010014889
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020014890It is important to understand that when multiple haproxy processes are started
14891on the same sockets, any process may pick up the request and will output its
14892own stats.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010014893
Willy Tarreau468f4932013-08-01 16:50:16 +020014894The list of commands currently supported on the stats socket is provided below.
14895If an unknown command is sent, haproxy displays the usage message which reminds
14896all supported commands. Some commands support a more complex syntax, generally
14897it will explain what part of the command is invalid when this happens.
14898
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010014899add acl <acl> <pattern>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010014900 Add an entry into the acl <acl>. <acl> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by
14901 "show acl". This command does not verify if the entry already exists. This
14902 command cannot be used if the reference <acl> is a file also used with a map.
14903 In this case, you must use the command "add map" in place of "add acl".
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010014904
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010014905add map <map> <key> <value>
14906 Add an entry into the map <map> to associate the value <value> to the key
14907 <key>. This command does not verify if the entry already exists. It is
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010014908 mainly used to fill a map after a clear operation. Note that if the reference
14909 <map> is a file and is shared with a map, this map will contain also a new
14910 pattern entry.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010014911
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014912clear counters
14913 Clear the max values of the statistics counters in each proxy (frontend &
14914 backend) and in each server. The cumulated counters are not affected. This
14915 can be used to get clean counters after an incident, without having to
14916 restart nor to clear traffic counters. This command is restricted and can
14917 only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
14918
14919clear counters all
14920 Clear all statistics counters in each proxy (frontend & backend) and in each
14921 server. This has the same effect as restarting. This command is restricted
14922 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin".
14923
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010014924clear acl <acl>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010014925 Remove all entries from the acl <acl>. <acl> is the #<id> or the <file>
14926 returned by "show acl". Note that if the reference <acl> is a file and is
14927 shared with a map, this map will be also cleared.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010014928
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010014929clear map <map>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010014930 Remove all entries from the map <map>. <map> is the #<id> or the <file>
14931 returned by "show map". Note that if the reference <map> is a file and is
14932 shared with a acl, this acl will be also cleared.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010014933
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090014934clear table <table> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
14935 Remove entries from the stick-table <table>.
14936
14937 This is typically used to unblock some users complaining they have been
14938 abusively denied access to a service, but this can also be used to clear some
14939 stickiness entries matching a server that is going to be replaced (see "show
14940 table" below for details). Note that sometimes, removal of an entry will be
14941 refused because it is currently tracked by a session. Retrying a few seconds
14942 later after the session ends is usual enough.
14943
14944 In the case where no options arguments are given all entries will be removed.
14945
14946 When the "data." form is used entries matching a filter applied using the
14947 stored data (see "stick-table" in section 4.2) are removed. A stored data
14948 type must be specified in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the
14949 table otherwise an error is reported. The data is compared according to
14950 <operator> with the 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with
14951 the ACLs :
14952
14953 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
14954 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
14955 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
14956 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
14957 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
14958 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
14959
14960 When the key form is used the entry <key> is removed. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090014961 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer and
14962 string.
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014963
14964 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014965 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020014966 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014967 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
14968 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
14969 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
14970 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014971
14972 $ echo "clear table http_proxy key 127.0.0.1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
14973
14974 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020014975 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014976 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
14977 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090014978 $ echo "clear table http_proxy data.gpc0 eq 1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
14979 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
14980 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014981
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010014982del acl <acl> [<key>|#<ref>]
14983 Delete all the acl entries from the acl <acl> corresponding to the key <key>.
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010014984 <acl> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show acl". If the <ref> is used,
14985 this command delete only the listed reference. The reference can be found with
14986 listing the content of the acl. Note that if the reference <acl> is a file and
14987 is shared with a map, the entry will be also deleted in the map.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010014988
14989del map <map> [<key>|#<ref>]
Thierry FOURNIER0b90f312014-01-29 20:40:18 +010014990 Delete all the map entries from the map <map> corresponding to the key <key>.
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010014991 <map> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show map". If the <ref> is used,
14992 this command delete only the listed reference. The reference can be found with
14993 listing the content of the map. Note that if the reference <map> is a file and
14994 is shared with a acl, the entry will be also deleted in the map.
Thierry FOURNIER0b90f312014-01-29 20:40:18 +010014995
14996disable agent <backend>/<server>
Simon Horman671b6f02013-11-25 10:46:39 +090014997 Mark the auxiliary agent check as temporarily stopped.
14998
14999 In the case where an agent check is being run as a auxiliary check, due
15000 to the agent-check parameter of a server directive, new checks are only
15001 initialised when the agent is in the enabled. Thus, disable agent will
15002 prevent any new agent checks from begin initiated until the agent
15003 re-enabled using enable agent.
15004
15005 When an agent is disabled the processing of an auxiliary agent check that
15006 was initiated while the agent was set as enabled is as follows: All
15007 results that would alter the weight, specifically "drain" or a weight
15008 returned by the agent, are ignored. The processing of agent check is
15009 otherwise unchanged.
15010
15011 The motivation for this feature is to allow the weight changing effects
15012 of the agent checks to be paused to allow the weight of a server to be
15013 configured using set weight without being overridden by the agent.
15014
15015 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
15016 level "admin".
15017
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020015018disable frontend <frontend>
15019 Mark the frontend as temporarily stopped. This corresponds to the mode which
15020 is used during a soft restart : the frontend releases the port but can be
15021 enabled again if needed. This should be used with care as some non-Linux OSes
15022 are unable to enable it back. This is intended to be used in environments
15023 where stopping a proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must
15024 be fixed. That way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another
15025 process to restore operations. The frontend will appear with status "STOP"
15026 on the stats page.
15027
15028 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
15029 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
15030
15031 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
15032 level "admin".
15033
Willy Tarreau9b5aecd2014-05-23 11:53:10 +020015034disable health <backend>/<server>
15035 Mark the primary health check as temporarily stopped. This will disable
15036 sending of health checks, and the last health check result will be ignored.
15037 The server will be in unchecked state and considered UP unless an auxiliary
15038 agent check forces it down.
15039
15040 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
15041 level "admin".
15042
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015043disable server <backend>/<server>
15044 Mark the server DOWN for maintenance. In this mode, no more checks will be
15045 performed on the server until it leaves maintenance.
15046 If the server is tracked by other servers, those servers will be set to DOWN
15047 during the maintenance.
15048
15049 In the statistics page, a server DOWN for maintenance will appear with a
15050 "MAINT" status, its tracking servers with the "MAINT(via)" one.
15051
15052 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020015053 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015054
15055 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
15056 level "admin".
15057
Simon Horman671b6f02013-11-25 10:46:39 +090015058enable agent <backend>/<server>
15059 Resume auxiliary agent check that was temporarily stopped.
15060
15061 See "disable agent" for details of the effect of temporarily starting
15062 and stopping an auxiliary agent.
15063
15064 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
15065 level "admin".
15066
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020015067enable frontend <frontend>
15068 Resume a frontend which was temporarily stopped. It is possible that some of
15069 the listening ports won't be able to bind anymore (eg: if another process
15070 took them since the 'disable frontend' operation). If this happens, an error
15071 is displayed. Some operating systems might not be able to resume a frontend
15072 which was disabled.
15073
15074 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
15075 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
15076
15077 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
15078 level "admin".
15079
Willy Tarreau9b5aecd2014-05-23 11:53:10 +020015080enable health <backend>/<server>
15081 Resume a primary health check that was temporarily stopped. This will enable
15082 sending of health checks again. Please see "disable health" for details.
15083
15084 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
15085 level "admin".
15086
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015087enable server <backend>/<server>
15088 If the server was previously marked as DOWN for maintenance, this marks the
15089 server UP and checks are re-enabled.
15090
15091 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020015092 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015093
15094 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
15095 level "admin".
15096
Thierry FOURNIER5b16df72014-02-26 18:07:38 +010015097get map <map> <value>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010015098get acl <acl> <value>
15099 Lookup the value <value> in the map <map> or in the ACL <acl>. <map> or <acl>
15100 are the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show map" or "show acl". This command
15101 returns all the matching patterns associated with this map. This is useful for
15102 debugging maps and ACLs. The output format is composed by one line par
15103 matching type. Each line is composed by space-delimited series of words.
Thierry FOURNIER5b16df72014-02-26 18:07:38 +010015104
15105 The first two words are:
15106
15107 <match method>: The match method applied. It can be "found", "bool",
15108 "int", "ip", "bin", "len", "str", "beg", "sub", "dir",
15109 "dom", "end" or "reg".
15110
15111 <match result>: The result. Can be "match" or "no-match".
15112
15113 The following words are returned only if the pattern matches an entry.
15114
15115 <index type>: "tree" or "list". The internal lookup algorithm.
15116
15117 <case>: "case-insensitive" or "case-sensitive". The
15118 interpretation of the case.
15119
15120 <entry matched>: match="<entry>". Return the matched pattern. It is
15121 useful with regular expressions.
15122
15123 The two last word are used to show the returned value and its type. With the
15124 "acl" case, the pattern doesn't exist.
15125
15126 return=nothing: No return because there are no "map".
15127 return="<value>": The value returned in the string format.
15128 return=cannot-display: The value cannot be converted as string.
15129
15130 type="<type>": The type of the returned sample.
15131
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015132get weight <backend>/<server>
15133 Report the current weight and the initial weight of server <server> in
15134 backend <backend> or an error if either doesn't exist. The initial weight is
15135 the one that appears in the configuration file. Both are normally equal
15136 unless the current weight has been changed. Both the backend and the server
15137 may be specified either by their name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020015138 sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015139
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020015140help
15141 Print the list of known keywords and their basic usage. The same help screen
15142 is also displayed for unknown commands.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010015143
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020015144prompt
15145 Toggle the prompt at the beginning of the line and enter or leave interactive
15146 mode. In interactive mode, the connection is not closed after a command
15147 completes. Instead, the prompt will appear again, indicating the user that
15148 the interpreter is waiting for a new command. The prompt consists in a right
15149 angle bracket followed by a space "> ". This mode is particularly convenient
15150 when one wants to periodically check information such as stats or errors.
15151 It is also a good idea to enter interactive mode before issuing a "help"
15152 command.
15153
15154quit
15155 Close the connection when in interactive mode.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010015156
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010015157set map <map> [<key>|#<ref>] <value>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010015158 Modify the value corresponding to each key <key> in a map <map>. <map> is the
15159 #<id> or <file> returned by "show map". If the <ref> is used in place of
15160 <key>, only the entry pointed by <ref> is changed. The new value is <value>.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010015161
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020015162set maxconn frontend <frontend> <value>
Willy Tarreau3c7a79d2012-09-26 21:07:15 +020015163 Dynamically change the specified frontend's maxconn setting. Any positive
15164 value is allowed including zero, but setting values larger than the global
15165 maxconn does not make much sense. If the limit is increased and connections
15166 were pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value
15167 below the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020015168 delayed until the threshold is reached. The frontend might be specified by
15169 either its name or its numeric ID prefixed with a sharp ('#').
15170
Willy Tarreau91886b62011-09-07 14:38:31 +020015171set maxconn global <maxconn>
15172 Dynamically change the global maxconn setting within the range defined by the
15173 initial global maxconn setting. If it is increased and connections were
15174 pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value below
15175 the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
15176 delayed until the threshold is reached. A value of zero restores the initial
15177 setting.
15178
Willy Tarreauf5b22872011-09-07 16:13:44 +020015179set rate-limit connections global <value>
15180 Change the process-wide connection rate limit, which is set by the global
15181 'maxconnrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
15182 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
15183 is passed in number of connections per second.
15184
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010015185set rate-limit http-compression global <value>
15186 Change the maximum input compression rate, which is set by the global
15187 'maxcomprate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. The value is
William Lallemand096f5542012-11-19 17:26:05 +010015188 passed in number of kilobytes per second. The value is available in the "show
15189 info" on the line "CompressBpsRateLim" in bytes.
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010015190
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +020015191set rate-limit sessions global <value>
15192 Change the process-wide session rate limit, which is set by the global
15193 'maxsessrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
15194 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
15195 is passed in number of sessions per second.
15196
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +020015197set rate-limit ssl-sessions global <value>
15198 Change the process-wide SSL session rate limit, which is set by the global
15199 'maxsslrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
15200 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
15201 is passed in number of sessions per second sent to the SSL stack. It applies
15202 before the handshake in order to protect the stack against handshake abuses.
15203
Baptiste Assmann3d8f8312015-04-13 22:54:33 +020015204set server <backend>/<server> addr <ip4 or ip6 address>
15205 Replace the current IP address of a server by the one provided.
15206
Willy Tarreau2a4b70f2014-05-22 18:42:35 +020015207set server <backend>/<server> agent [ up | down ]
15208 Force a server's agent to a new state. This can be useful to immediately
15209 switch a server's state regardless of some slow agent checks for example.
15210 Note that the change is propagated to tracking servers if any.
15211
15212set server <backend>/<server> health [ up | stopping | down ]
15213 Force a server's health to a new state. This can be useful to immediately
15214 switch a server's state regardless of some slow health checks for example.
15215 Note that the change is propagated to tracking servers if any.
15216
15217set server <backend>/<server> state [ ready | drain | maint ]
15218 Force a server's administrative state to a new state. This can be useful to
15219 disable load balancing and/or any traffic to a server. Setting the state to
15220 "ready" puts the server in normal mode, and the command is the equivalent of
15221 the "enable server" command. Setting the state to "maint" disables any traffic
15222 to the server as well as any health checks. This is the equivalent of the
15223 "disable server" command. Setting the mode to "drain" only removes the server
15224 from load balancing but still allows it to be checked and to accept new
15225 persistent connections. Changes are propagated to tracking servers if any.
15226
15227set server <backend>/<server> weight <weight>[%]
15228 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. This is the exact
15229 equivalent of the "set weight" command below.
15230
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020015231set ssl ocsp-response <response>
15232 This command is used to update an OCSP Response for a certificate (see "crt"
15233 on "bind" lines). Same controls are performed as during the initial loading of
15234 the response. The <response> must be passed as a base64 encoded string of the
15235 DER encoded response from the OCSP server.
15236
15237 Example:
15238 openssl ocsp -issuer issuer.pem -cert server.pem \
15239 -host ocsp.issuer.com:80 -respout resp.der
15240 echo "set ssl ocsp-response $(base64 -w 10000 resp.der)" | \
15241 socat stdio /var/run/haproxy.stat
15242
Nenad Merdanovicc6985f02015-05-09 08:46:02 +020015243set ssl tls-key <id> <tlskey>
15244 Set the next TLS key for the <id> listener to <tlskey>. This key becomes the
15245 ultimate key, while the penultimate one is used for encryption (others just
15246 decrypt). The oldest TLS key present is overwritten. <id> is either a numeric
15247 #<id> or <file> returned by "show tls-keys". <tlskey> is a base64 encoded 48
15248 bit TLS ticket key (ex. openssl rand -base64 48).
15249
Willy Tarreau47060b62013-08-01 21:11:42 +020015250set table <table> key <key> [data.<data_type> <value>]*
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020015251 Create or update a stick-table entry in the table. If the key is not present,
15252 an entry is inserted. See stick-table in section 4.2 to find all possible
15253 values for <data_type>. The most likely use consists in dynamically entering
15254 entries for source IP addresses, with a flag in gpc0 to dynamically block an
Willy Tarreau47060b62013-08-01 21:11:42 +020015255 IP address or affect its quality of service. It is possible to pass multiple
15256 data_types in a single call.
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020015257
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015258set timeout cli <delay>
15259 Change the CLI interface timeout for current connection. This can be useful
15260 during long debugging sessions where the user needs to constantly inspect
15261 some indicators without being disconnected. The delay is passed in seconds.
15262
15263set weight <backend>/<server> <weight>[%]
15264 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. If the value ends
15265 with the '%' sign, then the new weight will be relative to the initially
Simon Horman58b5d292013-02-12 10:45:52 +090015266 configured weight. Absolute weights are permitted between 0 and 256.
15267 Relative weights must be positive with the resulting absolute weight is
15268 capped at 256. Servers which are part of a farm running a static
15269 load-balancing algorithm have stricter limitations because the weight
15270 cannot change once set. Thus for these servers, the only accepted values
15271 are 0 and 100% (or 0 and the initial weight). Changes take effect
15272 immediately, though certain LB algorithms require a certain amount of
15273 requests to consider changes. A typical usage of this command is to
15274 disable a server during an update by setting its weight to zero, then to
15275 enable it again after the update by setting it back to 100%. This command
15276 is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for level
15277 "admin". Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their
15278 name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015279
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010015280show errors [<iid>]
15281 Dump last known request and response errors collected by frontends and
15282 backends. If <iid> is specified, the limit the dump to errors concerning
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020015283 either frontend or backend whose ID is <iid>. This command is restricted
15284 and can only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or
15285 "admin".
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010015286
15287 The errors which may be collected are the last request and response errors
15288 caused by protocol violations, often due to invalid characters in header
15289 names. The report precisely indicates what exact character violated the
15290 protocol. Other important information such as the exact date the error was
15291 detected, frontend and backend names, the server name (when known), the
15292 internal session ID and the source address which has initiated the session
15293 are reported too.
15294
15295 All characters are returned, and non-printable characters are encoded. The
15296 most common ones (\t = 9, \n = 10, \r = 13 and \e = 27) are encoded as one
15297 letter following a backslash. The backslash itself is encoded as '\\' to
15298 avoid confusion. Other non-printable characters are encoded '\xNN' where
15299 NN is the two-digits hexadecimal representation of the character's ASCII
15300 code.
15301
15302 Lines are prefixed with the position of their first character, starting at 0
15303 for the beginning of the buffer. At most one input line is printed per line,
15304 and large lines will be broken into multiple consecutive output lines so that
15305 the output never goes beyond 79 characters wide. It is easy to detect if a
15306 line was broken, because it will not end with '\n' and the next line's offset
15307 will be followed by a '+' sign, indicating it is a continuation of previous
15308 line.
15309
15310 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020015311 $ echo "show errors" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
15312 >>> [04/Mar/2009:15:46:56.081] backend http-in (#2) : invalid response
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010015313 src 127.0.0.1, session #54, frontend fe-eth0 (#1), server s2 (#1)
15314 response length 213 bytes, error at position 23:
15315
15316 00000 HTTP/1.0 200 OK\r\n
15317 00017 header/bizarre:blah\r\n
15318 00038 Location: blah\r\n
15319 00054 Long-line: this is a very long line which should b
15320 00104+ e broken into multiple lines on the output buffer,
15321 00154+ otherwise it would be too large to print in a ter
15322 00204+ minal\r\n
15323 00211 \r\n
15324
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015325 In the example above, we see that the backend "http-in" which has internal
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010015326 ID 2 has blocked an invalid response from its server s2 which has internal
15327 ID 1. The request was on session 54 initiated by source 127.0.0.1 and
15328 received by frontend fe-eth0 whose ID is 1. The total response length was
15329 213 bytes when the error was detected, and the error was at byte 23. This
15330 is the slash ('/') in header name "header/bizarre", which is not a valid
15331 HTTP character for a header name.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010015332
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020015333show info
15334 Dump info about haproxy status on current process.
15335
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010015336show map [<map>]
15337 Dump info about map converters. Without argument, the list of all available
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010015338 maps is returned. If a <map> is specified, its contents are dumped. <map> is
15339 the #<id> or <file>. The first column is a unique identifier. It can be used
15340 as reference for the operation "del map" and "set map". The second column is
15341 the pattern and the third column is the sample if available. The data returned
15342 are not directly a list of available maps, but are the list of all patterns
15343 composing any map. Many of these patterns can be shared with ACL.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010015344
15345show acl [<acl>]
15346 Dump info about acl converters. Without argument, the list of all available
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010015347 acls is returned. If a <acl> is specified, its contents are dumped. <acl> if
15348 the #<id> or <file>. The dump format is the same than the map even for the
15349 sample value. The data returned are not a list of available ACL, but are the
15350 list of all patterns composing any ACL. Many of these patterns can be shared
15351 with maps.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010015352
Willy Tarreau12833bb2014-01-28 16:49:56 +010015353show pools
15354 Dump the status of internal memory pools. This is useful to track memory
15355 usage when suspecting a memory leak for example. It does exactly the same
15356 as the SIGQUIT when running in foreground except that it does not flush
15357 the pools.
15358
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020015359show sess
15360 Dump all known sessions. Avoid doing this on slow connections as this can
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020015361 be huge. This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets
15362 configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
15363
Willy Tarreau66dc20a2010-03-05 17:53:32 +010015364show sess <id>
15365 Display a lot of internal information about the specified session identifier.
15366 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
15367 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). Those information are
15368 useless to most users but may be used by haproxy developers to troubleshoot a
15369 complex bug. The output format is intentionally not documented so that it can
Olivierce31e6e2014-09-05 18:49:10 +020015370 freely evolve depending on demands. You may find a description of all fields
15371 returned in src/dumpstats.c
15372
15373 The special id "all" dumps the states of all sessions, which must be avoided
15374 as much as possible as it is highly CPU intensive and can take a lot of time.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020015375
15376show stat [<iid> <type> <sid>]
15377 Dump statistics in the CSV format. By passing <id>, <type> and <sid>, it is
15378 possible to dump only selected items :
15379 - <iid> is a proxy ID, -1 to dump everything
15380 - <type> selects the type of dumpable objects : 1 for frontends, 2 for
15381 backends, 4 for servers, -1 for everything. These values can be ORed,
15382 for example:
15383 1 + 2 = 3 -> frontend + backend.
15384 1 + 2 + 4 = 7 -> frontend + backend + server.
15385 - <sid> is a server ID, -1 to dump everything from the selected proxy.
15386
15387 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020015388 $ echo "show info;show stat" | socat stdio unix-connect:/tmp/sock1
15389 >>> Name: HAProxy
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020015390 Version: 1.4-dev2-49
15391 Release_date: 2009/09/23
15392 Nbproc: 1
15393 Process_num: 1
15394 (...)
15395
15396 # pxname,svname,qcur,qmax,scur,smax,slim,stot,bin,bout,dreq, (...)
15397 stats,FRONTEND,,,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,0,,,,,OPEN,,,,,,,,,1,1,0, (...)
15398 stats,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,0,0,0,,0,250,(...)
15399 (...)
15400 www1,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,1,1,0,,0,250, (...)
15401
15402 $
15403
15404 Here, two commands have been issued at once. That way it's easy to find
15405 which process the stats apply to in multi-process mode. Notice the empty
15406 line after the information output which marks the end of the first block.
15407 A similar empty line appears at the end of the second block (stats) so that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010015408 the reader knows the output has not been truncated.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020015409
Baptiste Assmann3863f972015-05-17 00:33:24 +020015410show stat resolvers <resolvers section id>
15411 Dump statistics for the given resolvers section.
15412 For each name server, the following counters are reported:
15413 sent: number of DNS requests sent to this server
15414 valid: number of DNS valid responses received from this server
15415 update: number of DNS responses used to update the server's IP address
15416 cname: number of CNAME responses
15417 cname_error: CNAME errors encountered with this server
15418 any_err: number of empty response (IE: server does not support ANY type)
15419 nx: non existent domain response received from this server
15420 timeout: how many time this server did not answer in time
15421 refused: number of requests refused by this server
15422 other: any other DNS errors
15423 invalid: invalid DNS response (from a protocol point of view)
15424 too_big: too big response
15425 outdated: number of response arrived too late (after an other name server)
15426
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020015427show table
15428 Dump general information on all known stick-tables. Their name is returned
15429 (the name of the proxy which holds them), their type (currently zero, always
15430 IP), their size in maximum possible number of entries, and the number of
15431 entries currently in use.
15432
15433 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020015434 $ echo "show table" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090015435 >>> # table: front_pub, type: ip, size:204800, used:171454
15436 >>> # table: back_rdp, type: ip, size:204800, used:0
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020015437
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090015438show table <name> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020015439 Dump contents of stick-table <name>. In this mode, a first line of generic
15440 information about the table is reported as with "show table", then all
15441 entries are dumped. Since this can be quite heavy, it is possible to specify
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090015442 a filter in order to specify what entries to display.
15443
15444 When the "data." form is used the filter applies to the stored data (see
15445 "stick-table" in section 4.2). A stored data type must be specified
15446 in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the table otherwise an
15447 error is reported. The data is compared according to <operator> with the
15448 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with the ACLs :
15449
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020015450 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
15451 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
15452 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
15453 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
15454 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
15455 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
15456
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090015457
15458 When the key form is used the entry <key> is shown. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090015459 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer,
15460 and string.
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090015461
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020015462 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020015463 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090015464 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020015465 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
15466 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
15467 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
15468 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020015469
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020015470 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090015471 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020015472 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
15473 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020015474
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020015475 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.conn_rate gt 5" | \
15476 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090015477 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020015478 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
15479 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020015480
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090015481 $ echo "show table http_proxy key 127.0.0.2" | \
15482 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090015483 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090015484 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
15485 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
15486
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020015487 When the data criterion applies to a dynamic value dependent on time such as
15488 a bytes rate, the value is dynamically computed during the evaluation of the
15489 entry in order to decide whether it has to be dumped or not. This means that
15490 such a filter could match for some time then not match anymore because as
15491 time goes, the average event rate drops.
15492
15493 It is possible to use this to extract lists of IP addresses abusing the
15494 service, in order to monitor them or even blacklist them in a firewall.
15495 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020015496 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" \
15497 | socat stdio /tmp/sock1 \
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020015498 | fgrep 'key=' | cut -d' ' -f2 | cut -d= -f2 > abusers-ip.txt
15499 ( or | awk '/key/{ print a[split($2,a,"=")]; }' )
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki719e7262009-10-04 15:02:46 +020015500
Nenad Merdanovicc6985f02015-05-09 08:46:02 +020015501show tls-keys
15502 Dump all loaded TLS ticket keys. The TLS ticket key reference ID and the
15503 file from which the keys have been loaded is shown. Both of those can be
15504 used to update the TLS keys using "set ssl tls-key".
15505
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020015506shutdown frontend <frontend>
15507 Completely delete the specified frontend. All the ports it was bound to will
15508 be released. It will not be possible to enable the frontend anymore after
15509 this operation. This is intended to be used in environments where stopping a
15510 proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must be fixed. That
15511 way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another process to
15512 restore operations. The frontend will not appear at all on the stats page
15513 once it is terminated.
15514
15515 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
15516 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
15517
15518 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
15519 level "admin".
15520
Willy Tarreaua295edc2011-09-07 23:21:03 +020015521shutdown session <id>
15522 Immediately terminate the session matching the specified session identifier.
15523 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
15524 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). This can be used to
15525 terminate a long-running session without waiting for a timeout or when an
15526 endless transfer is ongoing. Such terminated sessions are reported with a 'K'
15527 flag in the logs.
15528
Cyril Bontée63a1eb2014-07-12 18:22:42 +020015529shutdown sessions server <backend>/<server>
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020015530 Immediately terminate all the sessions attached to the specified server. This
15531 can be used to terminate long-running sessions after a server is put into
15532 maintenance mode, for instance. Such terminated sessions are reported with a
15533 'K' flag in the logs.
15534
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015535/*
15536 * Local variables:
15537 * fill-column: 79
15538 * End:
15539 */